blob: 19abe20035394d07d1191b434f89124ecee8f6ea [file] [log] [blame]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001#
Wolfgang Denkeca3aeb2013-06-21 10:22:36 +02002# (C) Copyright 2000 - 2013
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003# Wolfgang Denk, DENX Software Engineering, wd@denx.de.
4#
Wolfgang Denkeca3aeb2013-06-21 10:22:36 +02005# SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0+
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006#
7
8Summary:
9========
10
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000011This directory contains the source code for U-Boot, a boot loader for
wdenke86e5a02004-10-17 21:12:06 +000012Embedded boards based on PowerPC, ARM, MIPS and several other
13processors, which can be installed in a boot ROM and used to
14initialize and test the hardware or to download and run application
15code.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000016
17The development of U-Boot is closely related to Linux: some parts of
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000018the source code originate in the Linux source tree, we have some
19header files in common, and special provision has been made to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000020support booting of Linux images.
21
22Some attention has been paid to make this software easily
23configurable and extendable. For instance, all monitor commands are
24implemented with the same call interface, so that it's very easy to
25add new commands. Also, instead of permanently adding rarely used
26code (for instance hardware test utilities) to the monitor, you can
27load and run it dynamically.
28
29
30Status:
31=======
32
33In general, all boards for which a configuration option exists in the
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000034Makefile have been tested to some extent and can be considered
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000035"working". In fact, many of them are used in production systems.
36
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000037In case of problems see the CHANGELOG and CREDITS files to find out
Albert ARIBAUD27af9302013-09-11 15:52:51 +020038who contributed the specific port. The boards.cfg file lists board
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010039maintainers.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000040
Robert P. J. Dayadb9d852012-11-14 02:03:20 +000041Note: There is no CHANGELOG file in the actual U-Boot source tree;
42it can be created dynamically from the Git log using:
43
44 make CHANGELOG
45
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000046
47Where to get help:
48==================
49
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000050In case you have questions about, problems with or contributions for
51U-Boot you should send a message to the U-Boot mailing list at
Peter Tyser0c325652008-09-10 09:18:34 -050052<u-boot@lists.denx.de>. There is also an archive of previous traffic
53on the mailing list - please search the archive before asking FAQ's.
54Please see http://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot and
55http://dir.gmane.org/gmane.comp.boot-loaders.u-boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000056
57
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010058Where to get source code:
59=========================
60
61The U-Boot source code is maintained in the git repository at
62git://www.denx.de/git/u-boot.git ; you can browse it online at
63http://www.denx.de/cgi-bin/gitweb.cgi?p=u-boot.git;a=summary
64
65The "snapshot" links on this page allow you to download tarballs of
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +020066any version you might be interested in. Official releases are also
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010067available for FTP download from the ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/
68directory.
69
Anatolij Gustschind4ee7112008-03-26 18:13:33 +010070Pre-built (and tested) images are available from
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010071ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/images/
72
73
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000074Where we come from:
75===================
76
77- start from 8xxrom sources
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000078- create PPCBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/ppcboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000079- clean up code
80- make it easier to add custom boards
81- make it possible to add other [PowerPC] CPUs
82- extend functions, especially:
83 * Provide extended interface to Linux boot loader
84 * S-Record download
85 * network boot
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +020086 * PCMCIA / CompactFlash / ATA disk / SCSI ... boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000087- create ARMBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/armboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000088- add other CPU families (starting with ARM)
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000089- create U-Boot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/u-boot)
Magnus Lilja0d28f342008-08-06 19:32:33 +020090- current project page: see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000091
92
93Names and Spelling:
94===================
95
96The "official" name of this project is "Das U-Boot". The spelling
97"U-Boot" shall be used in all written text (documentation, comments
98in source files etc.). Example:
99
100 This is the README file for the U-Boot project.
101
102File names etc. shall be based on the string "u-boot". Examples:
103
104 include/asm-ppc/u-boot.h
105
106 #include <asm/u-boot.h>
107
108Variable names, preprocessor constants etc. shall be either based on
109the string "u_boot" or on "U_BOOT". Example:
110
111 U_BOOT_VERSION u_boot_logo
112 IH_OS_U_BOOT u_boot_hush_start
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000113
114
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000115Versioning:
116===========
117
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200118Starting with the release in October 2008, the names of the releases
119were changed from numerical release numbers without deeper meaning
120into a time stamp based numbering. Regular releases are identified by
121names consisting of the calendar year and month of the release date.
122Additional fields (if present) indicate release candidates or bug fix
123releases in "stable" maintenance trees.
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000124
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200125Examples:
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +0000126 U-Boot v2009.11 - Release November 2009
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200127 U-Boot v2009.11.1 - Release 1 in version November 2009 stable tree
128 U-Boot v2010.09-rc1 - Release candiate 1 for September 2010 release
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000129
130
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000131Directory Hierarchy:
132====================
133
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500134/arch Architecture specific files
Masahiro Yamada6eae68e2014-03-07 18:02:02 +0900135 /arc Files generic to ARC architecture
136 /cpu CPU specific files
137 /arc700 Files specific to ARC 700 CPUs
138 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500139 /arm Files generic to ARM architecture
140 /cpu CPU specific files
141 /arm720t Files specific to ARM 720 CPUs
142 /arm920t Files specific to ARM 920 CPUs
Andreas Bießmann6eb09212011-07-18 09:41:08 +0000143 /at91 Files specific to Atmel AT91RM9200 CPU
Wolfgang Denka9046b92010-06-13 17:48:15 +0200144 /imx Files specific to Freescale MC9328 i.MX CPUs
145 /s3c24x0 Files specific to Samsung S3C24X0 CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500146 /arm926ejs Files specific to ARM 926 CPUs
147 /arm1136 Files specific to ARM 1136 CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500148 /pxa Files specific to Intel XScale PXA CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500149 /sa1100 Files specific to Intel StrongARM SA1100 CPUs
150 /lib Architecture specific library files
151 /avr32 Files generic to AVR32 architecture
152 /cpu CPU specific files
153 /lib Architecture specific library files
154 /blackfin Files generic to Analog Devices Blackfin architecture
155 /cpu CPU specific files
156 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500157 /m68k Files generic to m68k architecture
158 /cpu CPU specific files
159 /mcf52x2 Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF52x2 CPUs
160 /mcf5227x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5227x CPUs
161 /mcf532x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5329 CPUs
162 /mcf5445x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5445x CPUs
163 /mcf547x_8x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF547x_8x CPUs
164 /lib Architecture specific library files
165 /microblaze Files generic to microblaze architecture
166 /cpu CPU specific files
167 /lib Architecture specific library files
168 /mips Files generic to MIPS architecture
169 /cpu CPU specific files
Daniel Schwierzeck92bbd642011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200170 /mips32 Files specific to MIPS32 CPUs
Masahiro Yamada6eae68e2014-03-07 18:02:02 +0900171 /mips64 Files specific to MIPS64 CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500172 /lib Architecture specific library files
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +0000173 /nds32 Files generic to NDS32 architecture
174 /cpu CPU specific files
175 /n1213 Files specific to Andes Technology N1213 CPUs
176 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500177 /nios2 Files generic to Altera NIOS2 architecture
178 /cpu CPU specific files
179 /lib Architecture specific library files
Robert P. J. Day33c77312013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400180 /openrisc Files generic to OpenRISC architecture
181 /cpu CPU specific files
182 /lib Architecture specific library files
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +0200183 /powerpc Files generic to PowerPC architecture
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500184 /cpu CPU specific files
185 /74xx_7xx Files specific to Freescale MPC74xx and 7xx CPUs
186 /mpc5xx Files specific to Freescale MPC5xx CPUs
187 /mpc5xxx Files specific to Freescale MPC5xxx CPUs
188 /mpc8xx Files specific to Freescale MPC8xx CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500189 /mpc824x Files specific to Freescale MPC824x CPUs
190 /mpc8260 Files specific to Freescale MPC8260 CPUs
191 /mpc85xx Files specific to Freescale MPC85xx CPUs
192 /ppc4xx Files specific to AMCC PowerPC 4xx CPUs
193 /lib Architecture specific library files
194 /sh Files generic to SH architecture
195 /cpu CPU specific files
196 /sh2 Files specific to sh2 CPUs
197 /sh3 Files specific to sh3 CPUs
198 /sh4 Files specific to sh4 CPUs
199 /lib Architecture specific library files
200 /sparc Files generic to SPARC architecture
201 /cpu CPU specific files
202 /leon2 Files specific to Gaisler LEON2 SPARC CPU
203 /leon3 Files specific to Gaisler LEON3 SPARC CPU
204 /lib Architecture specific library files
Robert P. J. Day33c77312013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400205 /x86 Files generic to x86 architecture
206 /cpu CPU specific files
207 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500208/api Machine/arch independent API for external apps
209/board Board dependent files
210/common Misc architecture independent functions
211/disk Code for disk drive partition handling
212/doc Documentation (don't expect too much)
213/drivers Commonly used device drivers
Robert P. J. Day33c77312013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400214/dts Contains Makefile for building internal U-Boot fdt.
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500215/examples Example code for standalone applications, etc.
216/fs Filesystem code (cramfs, ext2, jffs2, etc.)
217/include Header Files
218/lib Files generic to all architectures
219 /libfdt Library files to support flattened device trees
220 /lzma Library files to support LZMA decompression
221 /lzo Library files to support LZO decompression
222/net Networking code
223/post Power On Self Test
Robert P. J. Day33c77312013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400224/spl Secondary Program Loader framework
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500225/tools Tools to build S-Record or U-Boot images, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000226
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000227Software Configuration:
228=======================
229
230Configuration is usually done using C preprocessor defines; the
231rationale behind that is to avoid dead code whenever possible.
232
233There are two classes of configuration variables:
234
235* Configuration _OPTIONS_:
236 These are selectable by the user and have names beginning with
237 "CONFIG_".
238
239* Configuration _SETTINGS_:
240 These depend on the hardware etc. and should not be meddled with if
241 you don't know what you're doing; they have names beginning with
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200242 "CONFIG_SYS_".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000243
244Later we will add a configuration tool - probably similar to or even
245identical to what's used for the Linux kernel. Right now, we have to
246do the configuration by hand, which means creating some symbolic
247links and editing some configuration files. We use the TQM8xxL boards
248as an example here.
249
250
251Selection of Processor Architecture and Board Type:
252---------------------------------------------------
253
254For all supported boards there are ready-to-use default
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +0200255configurations available; just type "make <board_name>_defconfig".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000256
257Example: For a TQM823L module type:
258
259 cd u-boot
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +0200260 make TQM823L_defconfig
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000261
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200262For the Cogent platform, you need to specify the CPU type as well;
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +0200263e.g. "make cogent_mpc8xx_defconfig". And also configure the cogent
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000264directory according to the instructions in cogent/README.
265
266
Simon Glass75b3c3a2014-03-22 17:12:59 -0600267Sandbox Environment:
268--------------------
269
270U-Boot can be built natively to run on a Linux host using the 'sandbox'
271board. This allows feature development which is not board- or architecture-
272specific to be undertaken on a native platform. The sandbox is also used to
273run some of U-Boot's tests.
274
Jagannadha Sutradharudu Teki6b1978f2014-08-31 21:19:43 +0530275See board/sandbox/README.sandbox for more details.
Simon Glass75b3c3a2014-03-22 17:12:59 -0600276
277
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000278Configuration Options:
279----------------------
280
281Configuration depends on the combination of board and CPU type; all
282such information is kept in a configuration file
283"include/configs/<board_name>.h".
284
285Example: For a TQM823L module, all configuration settings are in
286"include/configs/TQM823L.h".
287
288
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +0000289Many of the options are named exactly as the corresponding Linux
290kernel configuration options. The intention is to make it easier to
291build a config tool - later.
292
293
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000294The following options need to be configured:
295
Kim Phillips26281142007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500296- CPU Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC85XX.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000297
Kim Phillips26281142007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500298- Board Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC8540ADS.
Wolfgang Denk6ccec442006-10-24 14:42:37 +0200299
300- CPU Daughterboard Type: (if CONFIG_ATSTK1000 is defined)
Haavard Skinnemoen09ea0de2007-11-01 12:44:20 +0100301 Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_ATSTK1002
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000302
303- CPU Module Type: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
304 Define exactly one of
305 CONFIG_CMA286_60_OLD
306--- FIXME --- not tested yet:
307 CONFIG_CMA286_60, CONFIG_CMA286_21, CONFIG_CMA286_60P,
308 CONFIG_CMA287_23, CONFIG_CMA287_50
309
310- Motherboard Type: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
311 Define exactly one of
312 CONFIG_CMA101, CONFIG_CMA102
313
314- Motherboard I/O Modules: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
315 Define one or more of
316 CONFIG_CMA302
317
318- Motherboard Options: (if CONFIG_CMA101 or CONFIG_CMA102 are defined)
319 Define one or more of
320 CONFIG_LCD_HEARTBEAT - update a character position on
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200321 the LCD display every second with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000322 a "rotator" |\-/|\-/
323
Lei Wencf946c62011-02-09 18:06:58 +0530324- Marvell Family Member
325 CONFIG_SYS_MVFS - define it if you want to enable
326 multiple fs option at one time
327 for marvell soc family
328
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000329- MPC824X Family Member (if CONFIG_MPC824X is defined)
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000330 Define exactly one of
331 CONFIG_MPC8240, CONFIG_MPC8245
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000332
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200333- 8xx CPU Options: (if using an MPC8xx CPU)
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000334 CONFIG_8xx_GCLK_FREQ - deprecated: CPU clock if
335 get_gclk_freq() cannot work
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000336 e.g. if there is no 32KHz
337 reference PIT/RTC clock
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000338 CONFIG_8xx_OSCLK - PLL input clock (either EXTCLK
339 or XTAL/EXTAL)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000340
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000341- 859/866/885 CPU options: (if using a MPC859 or MPC866 or MPC885 CPU):
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200342 CONFIG_SYS_8xx_CPUCLK_MIN
343 CONFIG_SYS_8xx_CPUCLK_MAX
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000344 CONFIG_8xx_CPUCLK_DEFAULT
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000345 See doc/README.MPC866
346
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200347 CONFIG_SYS_MEASURE_CPUCLK
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000348
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000349 Define this to measure the actual CPU clock instead
350 of relying on the correctness of the configured
351 values. Mostly useful for board bringup to make sure
352 the PLL is locked at the intended frequency. Note
353 that this requires a (stable) reference clock (32 kHz
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200354 RTC clock or CONFIG_SYS_8XX_XIN)
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000355
Heiko Schocher506f3912009-03-12 07:37:15 +0100356 CONFIG_SYS_DELAYED_ICACHE
357
358 Define this option if you want to enable the
359 ICache only when Code runs from RAM.
360
Kumar Gala66412c62011-02-18 05:40:54 -0600361- 85xx CPU Options:
York Sunffd06e02012-10-08 07:44:30 +0000362 CONFIG_SYS_PPC64
363
364 Specifies that the core is a 64-bit PowerPC implementation (implements
365 the "64" category of the Power ISA). This is necessary for ePAPR
366 compliance, among other possible reasons.
367
Kumar Gala66412c62011-02-18 05:40:54 -0600368 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_TBCLK_DIV
369
370 Defines the core time base clock divider ratio compared to the
371 system clock. On most PQ3 devices this is 8, on newer QorIQ
372 devices it can be 16 or 32. The ratio varies from SoC to Soc.
373
Kumar Gala8f290842011-05-20 00:39:21 -0500374 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PCIE_COMPAT
375
376 Defines the string to utilize when trying to match PCIe device
377 tree nodes for the given platform.
378
Prabhakar Kushwahaafa6b552012-04-29 23:56:13 +0000379 CONFIG_SYS_PPC_E500_DEBUG_TLB
380
381 Enables a temporary TLB entry to be used during boot to work
382 around limitations in e500v1 and e500v2 external debugger
383 support. This reduces the portions of the boot code where
384 breakpoints and single stepping do not work. The value of this
385 symbol should be set to the TLB1 entry to be used for this
386 purpose.
387
Scott Wood33eee332012-08-14 10:14:53 +0000388 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510
389
390 Enables a workaround for erratum A004510. If set,
391 then CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV and
392 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY must be set.
393
394 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV
395 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV2 (optional)
396
397 Defines one or two SoC revisions (low 8 bits of SVR)
398 for which the A004510 workaround should be applied.
399
400 The rest of SVR is either not relevant to the decision
401 of whether the erratum is present (e.g. p2040 versus
402 p2041) or is implied by the build target, which controls
403 whether CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510 is set.
404
405 See Freescale App Note 4493 for more information about
406 this erratum.
407
Prabhakar Kushwaha74fa22e2013-04-16 13:27:44 +0530408 CONFIG_A003399_NOR_WORKAROUND
409 Enables a workaround for IFC erratum A003399. It is only
410 requred during NOR boot.
411
Scott Wood33eee332012-08-14 10:14:53 +0000412 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY
413
414 This is the value to write into CCSR offset 0x18600
415 according to the A004510 workaround.
416
Priyanka Jain64501c62013-07-02 09:21:04 +0530417 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_DDR_ADDR
418 This value denotes start offset of DDR memory which is
419 connected exclusively to the DSP cores.
420
Priyanka Jain765b0bd2013-04-04 09:31:54 +0530421 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_M2_RAM_ADDR
422 This value denotes start offset of M2 memory
423 which is directly connected to the DSP core.
424
Priyanka Jain64501c62013-07-02 09:21:04 +0530425 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_M3_RAM_ADDR
426 This value denotes start offset of M3 memory which is directly
427 connected to the DSP core.
428
Priyanka Jain765b0bd2013-04-04 09:31:54 +0530429 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT
430 This value denotes start offset of DSP CCSR space.
431
Priyanka Jainb1359912013-12-17 14:25:52 +0530432 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_SINGLE_SOURCE_CLK
433 Single Source Clock is clocking mode present in some of FSL SoC's.
434 In this mode, a single differential clock is used to supply
435 clocks to the sysclock, ddrclock and usbclock.
436
Aneesh Bansalfb4a2402014-03-18 23:40:26 +0530437 CONFIG_SYS_CPC_REINIT_F
438 This CONFIG is defined when the CPC is configured as SRAM at the
439 time of U-boot entry and is required to be re-initialized.
440
Tang Yuantianaade2002014-04-17 15:33:46 +0800441 CONFIG_DEEP_SLEEP
442 Inidcates this SoC supports deep sleep feature. If deep sleep is
443 supported, core will start to execute uboot when wakes up.
444
Daniel Schwierzeck6cb461b2012-04-02 02:57:56 +0000445- Generic CPU options:
York Sun2a1680e2014-05-02 17:28:04 -0700446 CONFIG_SYS_GENERIC_GLOBAL_DATA
447 Defines global data is initialized in generic board board_init_f().
448 If this macro is defined, global data is created and cleared in
449 generic board board_init_f(). Without this macro, architecture/board
450 should initialize global data before calling board_init_f().
451
Daniel Schwierzeck6cb461b2012-04-02 02:57:56 +0000452 CONFIG_SYS_BIG_ENDIAN, CONFIG_SYS_LITTLE_ENDIAN
453
454 Defines the endianess of the CPU. Implementation of those
455 values is arch specific.
456
York Sun5614e712013-09-30 09:22:09 -0700457 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR
458 Freescale DDR driver in use. This type of DDR controller is
459 found in mpc83xx, mpc85xx, mpc86xx as well as some ARM core
460 SoCs.
461
462 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_ADDR
463 Freescale DDR memory-mapped register base.
464
465 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_EMU
466 Specify emulator support for DDR. Some DDR features such as
467 deskew training are not available.
468
469 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN1
470 Freescale DDR1 controller.
471
472 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN2
473 Freescale DDR2 controller.
474
475 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN3
476 Freescale DDR3 controller.
477
York Sun34e026f2014-03-27 17:54:47 -0700478 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN4
479 Freescale DDR4 controller.
480
York Sun9ac4ffb2013-09-30 14:20:51 -0700481 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_ARM_GEN3
482 Freescale DDR3 controller for ARM-based SoCs.
483
York Sun5614e712013-09-30 09:22:09 -0700484 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR1
485 Board config to use DDR1. It can be enabled for SoCs with
486 Freescale DDR1 or DDR2 controllers, depending on the board
487 implemetation.
488
489 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR2
490 Board config to use DDR2. It can be eanbeld for SoCs with
491 Freescale DDR2 or DDR3 controllers, depending on the board
492 implementation.
493
494 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR3
495 Board config to use DDR3. It can be enabled for SoCs with
York Sun34e026f2014-03-27 17:54:47 -0700496 Freescale DDR3 or DDR3L controllers.
497
498 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR3L
499 Board config to use DDR3L. It can be enabled for SoCs with
500 DDR3L controllers.
501
502 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR4
503 Board config to use DDR4. It can be enabled for SoCs with
504 DDR4 controllers.
York Sun5614e712013-09-30 09:22:09 -0700505
Prabhakar Kushwaha1b4175d2014-01-18 12:28:30 +0530506 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_IFC_BE
507 Defines the IFC controller register space as Big Endian
508
509 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_IFC_LE
510 Defines the IFC controller register space as Little Endian
511
Prabhakar Kushwaha690e4252014-01-13 11:28:04 +0530512 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PBL_PBI
513 It enables addition of RCW (Power on reset configuration) in built image.
514 Please refer doc/README.pblimage for more details
515
516 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PBL_RCW
517 It adds PBI(pre-boot instructions) commands in u-boot build image.
518 PBI commands can be used to configure SoC before it starts the execution.
519 Please refer doc/README.pblimage for more details
520
Prabhakar Kushwaha89ad7be2014-04-08 19:13:34 +0530521 CONFIG_SPL_FSL_PBL
522 It adds a target to create boot binary having SPL binary in PBI format
523 concatenated with u-boot binary.
524
York Sun4e5b1bd2014-02-10 13:59:42 -0800525 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_BE
526 Defines the DDR controller register space as Big Endian
527
528 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_LE
529 Defines the DDR controller register space as Little Endian
530
York Sun6b9e3092014-02-10 13:59:43 -0800531 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_SDRAM_BASE_PHY
532 Physical address from the view of DDR controllers. It is the
533 same as CONFIG_SYS_DDR_SDRAM_BASE for all Power SoCs. But
534 it could be different for ARM SoCs.
535
York Sun6b1e1252014-02-10 13:59:44 -0800536 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_INTLV_256B
537 DDR controller interleaving on 256-byte. This is a special
538 interleaving mode, handled by Dickens for Freescale layerscape
539 SoCs with ARM core.
540
York Sun1d71efb2014-08-01 15:51:00 -0700541 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_MAIN_NUM_CTRLS
542 Number of controllers used as main memory.
543
544 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_OTHER_DDR_NUM_CTRLS
545 Number of controllers used for other than main memory.
546
Ruchika Gupta028dbb82014-09-09 11:50:31 +0530547 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_SEC_BE
548 Defines the SEC controller register space as Big Endian
549
550 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_SEC_LE
551 Defines the SEC controller register space as Little Endian
552
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100553- Intel Monahans options:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200554 CONFIG_SYS_MONAHANS_RUN_MODE_OSC_RATIO
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100555
556 Defines the Monahans run mode to oscillator
557 ratio. Valid values are 8, 16, 24, 31. The core
558 frequency is this value multiplied by 13 MHz.
559
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200560 CONFIG_SYS_MONAHANS_TURBO_RUN_MODE_RATIO
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200561
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100562 Defines the Monahans turbo mode to oscillator
563 ratio. Valid values are 1 (default if undefined) and
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200564 2. The core frequency as calculated above is multiplied
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100565 by this value.
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200566
Daniel Schwierzeck92bbd642011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200567- MIPS CPU options:
568 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_SP_OFFSET
569
570 Offset relative to CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE for initial stack
571 pointer. This is needed for the temporary stack before
572 relocation.
573
574 CONFIG_SYS_MIPS_CACHE_MODE
575
576 Cache operation mode for the MIPS CPU.
577 See also arch/mips/include/asm/mipsregs.h.
578 Possible values are:
579 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NO_WA
580 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_WA
581 CONF_CM_UNCACHED
582 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NONCOHERENT
583 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CE
584 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_COW
585 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CUW
586 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_ACCELERATED
587
588 CONFIG_SYS_XWAY_EBU_BOOTCFG
589
590 Special option for Lantiq XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash.
591 See also arch/mips/cpu/mips32/start.S.
592
593 CONFIG_XWAY_SWAP_BYTES
594
595 Enable compilation of tools/xway-swap-bytes needed for Lantiq
596 XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash. The U-Boot image needs to
597 be swapped if a flash programmer is used.
598
Christian Rieschb67d8812012-02-02 00:44:39 +0000599- ARM options:
600 CONFIG_SYS_EXCEPTION_VECTORS_HIGH
601
602 Select high exception vectors of the ARM core, e.g., do not
603 clear the V bit of the c1 register of CP15.
604
Aneesh V5356f542012-03-08 07:20:19 +0000605 CONFIG_SYS_THUMB_BUILD
606
607 Use this flag to build U-Boot using the Thumb instruction
608 set for ARM architectures. Thumb instruction set provides
609 better code density. For ARM architectures that support
610 Thumb2 this flag will result in Thumb2 code generated by
611 GCC.
612
Stephen Warrenc5d47522013-03-04 13:29:40 +0000613 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_716044
Stephen Warren06785872013-02-26 12:28:27 +0000614 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_742230
615 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_743622
616 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_751472
Nitin Gargf71cbfe2014-04-02 08:55:01 -0500617 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_794072
Nitin Gargb7588e32014-04-02 08:55:02 -0500618 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_761320
Stephen Warren06785872013-02-26 12:28:27 +0000619
620 If set, the workarounds for these ARM errata are applied early
621 during U-Boot startup. Note that these options force the
622 workarounds to be applied; no CPU-type/version detection
623 exists, unlike the similar options in the Linux kernel. Do not
624 set these options unless they apply!
625
Stephen Warren795659d2013-03-27 17:06:41 +0000626- CPU timer options:
627 CONFIG_SYS_HZ
628
629 The frequency of the timer returned by get_timer().
630 get_timer() must operate in milliseconds and this CONFIG
631 option must be set to 1000.
632
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000633- Linux Kernel Interface:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000634 CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ
635
636 U-Boot stores all clock information in Hz
637 internally. For binary compatibility with older Linux
638 kernels (which expect the clocks passed in the
639 bd_info data to be in MHz) the environment variable
640 "clocks_in_mhz" can be defined so that U-Boot
641 converts clock data to MHZ before passing it to the
642 Linux kernel.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000643 When CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ is defined, a definition of
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +0100644 "clocks_in_mhz=1" is automatically included in the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000645 default environment.
646
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000647 CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES [relevant for MIPS only]
648
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200649 When transferring memsize parameter to linux, some versions
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000650 expect it to be in bytes, others in MB.
651 Define CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES to make it in bytes.
652
Gerald Van Barenfec6d9e2008-06-03 20:34:45 -0400653 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200654
655 New kernel versions are expecting firmware settings to be
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400656 passed using flattened device trees (based on open firmware
657 concepts).
658
659 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
660 * New libfdt-based support
661 * Adds the "fdt" command
Kim Phillips3bb342f2007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500662 * The bootm command automatically updates the fdt
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400663
Marcel Ziswilerb55ae402009-09-09 21:18:41 +0200664 OF_CPU - The proper name of the cpus node (only required for
665 MPC512X and MPC5xxx based boards).
666 OF_SOC - The proper name of the soc node (only required for
667 MPC512X and MPC5xxx based boards).
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200668 OF_TBCLK - The timebase frequency.
Kumar Galac2871f02006-01-11 13:59:02 -0600669 OF_STDOUT_PATH - The path to the console device
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200670
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200671 boards with QUICC Engines require OF_QE to set UCC MAC
672 addresses
Kim Phillips3bb342f2007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500673
Kumar Gala4e253132006-01-11 13:54:17 -0600674 CONFIG_OF_BOARD_SETUP
675
676 Board code has addition modification that it wants to make
677 to the flat device tree before handing it off to the kernel
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000678
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -0500679 CONFIG_OF_BOOT_CPU
680
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200681 This define fills in the correct boot CPU in the boot
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -0500682 param header, the default value is zero if undefined.
683
Heiko Schocher3887c3f2009-09-23 07:56:08 +0200684 CONFIG_OF_IDE_FIXUP
685
686 U-Boot can detect if an IDE device is present or not.
687 If not, and this new config option is activated, U-Boot
688 removes the ATA node from the DTS before booting Linux,
689 so the Linux IDE driver does not probe the device and
690 crash. This is needed for buggy hardware (uc101) where
691 no pull down resistor is connected to the signal IDE5V_DD7.
692
Igor Grinberg7eb29392011-07-14 05:45:07 +0000693 CONFIG_MACH_TYPE [relevant for ARM only][mandatory]
694
695 This setting is mandatory for all boards that have only one
696 machine type and must be used to specify the machine type
697 number as it appears in the ARM machine registry
698 (see http://www.arm.linux.org.uk/developer/machines/).
699 Only boards that have multiple machine types supported
700 in a single configuration file and the machine type is
701 runtime discoverable, do not have to use this setting.
702
Niklaus Giger0b2f4ec2008-11-03 22:13:47 +0100703- vxWorks boot parameters:
704
705 bootvx constructs a valid bootline using the following
706 environments variables: bootfile, ipaddr, serverip, hostname.
707 It loads the vxWorks image pointed bootfile.
708
709 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_BOOT_DEVICE - The vxworks device name
710 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_MAC_PTR - Ethernet 6 byte MA -address
711 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_SERVERNAME - Name of the server
712 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_BOOT_ADDR - Address of boot parameters
713
714 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_ADD_PARAMS
715
716 Add it at the end of the bootline. E.g "u=username pw=secret"
717
718 Note: If a "bootargs" environment is defined, it will overwride
719 the defaults discussed just above.
720
Aneesh V2c451f72011-06-16 23:30:47 +0000721- Cache Configuration:
722 CONFIG_SYS_ICACHE_OFF - Do not enable instruction cache in U-Boot
723 CONFIG_SYS_DCACHE_OFF - Do not enable data cache in U-Boot
724 CONFIG_SYS_L2CACHE_OFF- Do not enable L2 cache in U-Boot
725
Aneesh V93bc2192011-06-16 23:30:51 +0000726- Cache Configuration for ARM:
727 CONFIG_SYS_L2_PL310 - Enable support for ARM PL310 L2 cache
728 controller
729 CONFIG_SYS_PL310_BASE - Physical base address of PL310
730 controller register space
731
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000732- Serial Ports:
Andreas Engel48d01922008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200733 CONFIG_PL010_SERIAL
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000734
735 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL010 UARTs.
736
Andreas Engel48d01922008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200737 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000738
739 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs.
740
741 CONFIG_PL011_CLOCK
742
743 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs, set this variable to
744 the clock speed of the UARTs.
745
746 CONFIG_PL01x_PORTS
747
748 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL010 or PL011 UARTs on your board,
749 define this to a list of base addresses for each (supported)
750 port. See e.g. include/configs/versatile.h
751
John Rigby910f1ae2011-04-19 10:42:39 +0000752 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL_RLCR
753
754 Some vendor versions of PL011 serial ports (e.g. ST-Ericsson U8500)
755 have separate receive and transmit line control registers. Set
756 this variable to initialize the extra register.
757
758 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL_FLUSH_ON_INIT
759
760 On some platforms (e.g. U8500) U-Boot is loaded by a second stage
761 boot loader that has already initialized the UART. Define this
762 variable to flush the UART at init time.
763
Karicheri, Muralidharand57dee52014-04-09 15:38:46 -0400764 CONFIG_SERIAL_HW_FLOW_CONTROL
765
766 Define this variable to enable hw flow control in serial driver.
767 Current user of this option is drivers/serial/nsl16550.c driver
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000768
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000769- Console Interface:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000770 Depending on board, define exactly one serial port
771 (like CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SMC1, CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SMC2,
772 CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SCC1, ...), or switch off the serial
773 console by defining CONFIG_8xx_CONS_NONE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000774
775 Note: if CONFIG_8xx_CONS_NONE is defined, the serial
776 port routines must be defined elsewhere
777 (i.e. serial_init(), serial_getc(), ...)
778
779 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
780 Enables console device for a color framebuffer. Needs following
Wolfgang Denkc53043b2011-12-07 12:19:20 +0000781 defines (cf. smiLynxEM, i8042)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000782 VIDEO_FB_LITTLE_ENDIAN graphic memory organisation
783 (default big endian)
784 VIDEO_HW_RECTFILL graphic chip supports
785 rectangle fill
786 (cf. smiLynxEM)
787 VIDEO_HW_BITBLT graphic chip supports
788 bit-blit (cf. smiLynxEM)
789 VIDEO_VISIBLE_COLS visible pixel columns
790 (cols=pitch)
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000791 VIDEO_VISIBLE_ROWS visible pixel rows
792 VIDEO_PIXEL_SIZE bytes per pixel
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000793 VIDEO_DATA_FORMAT graphic data format
794 (0-5, cf. cfb_console.c)
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000795 VIDEO_FB_ADRS framebuffer address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000796 VIDEO_KBD_INIT_FCT keyboard int fct
797 (i.e. i8042_kbd_init())
798 VIDEO_TSTC_FCT test char fct
799 (i.e. i8042_tstc)
800 VIDEO_GETC_FCT get char fct
801 (i.e. i8042_getc)
802 CONFIG_CONSOLE_CURSOR cursor drawing on/off
803 (requires blink timer
804 cf. i8042.c)
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200805 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_BLINK_COUNT blink interval (cf. i8042.c)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000806 CONFIG_CONSOLE_TIME display time/date info in
807 upper right corner
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500808 (requires CONFIG_CMD_DATE)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000809 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO display Linux logo in
810 upper left corner
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +0000811 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO use bmp_logo.h instead of
812 linux_logo.h for logo.
813 Requires CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000814 CONFIG_CONSOLE_EXTRA_INFO
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200815 additional board info beside
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000816 the logo
817
Pali Rohár33a35bb2012-10-19 13:30:09 +0000818 When CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE_ANSI is defined, console will support
819 a limited number of ANSI escape sequences (cursor control,
820 erase functions and limited graphics rendition control).
821
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000822 When CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE is defined, video console is
823 default i/o. Serial console can be forced with
824 environment 'console=serial'.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000825
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +0000826 When CONFIG_SILENT_CONSOLE is defined, all console
827 messages (by U-Boot and Linux!) can be silenced with
828 the "silent" environment variable. See
829 doc/README.silent for more information.
wdenka3ad8e22003-10-19 23:22:11 +0000830
Heiko Schocher45ae2542013-10-22 11:06:06 +0200831 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_BG_COL: define the backgroundcolor, default
832 is 0x00.
833 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_FG_COL: define the foregroundcolor, default
834 is 0xa0.
835
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000836- Console Baudrate:
837 CONFIG_BAUDRATE - in bps
838 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200839 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
840 CONFIG_SYS_BRGCLK_PRESCALE, baudrate prescale
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000841
Heiko Schocherc92fac92009-01-30 12:55:38 +0100842- Console Rx buffer length
843 With CONFIG_SYS_SMC_RXBUFLEN it is possible to define
844 the maximum receive buffer length for the SMC.
Heiko Schocher2b3f12c2009-02-10 09:31:47 +0100845 This option is actual only for 82xx and 8xx possible.
Heiko Schocherc92fac92009-01-30 12:55:38 +0100846 If using CONFIG_SYS_SMC_RXBUFLEN also CONFIG_SYS_MAXIDLE
847 must be defined, to setup the maximum idle timeout for
848 the SMC.
849
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000850- Pre-Console Buffer:
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200851 Prior to the console being initialised (i.e. serial UART
852 initialised etc) all console output is silently discarded.
853 Defining CONFIG_PRE_CONSOLE_BUFFER will cause U-Boot to
854 buffer any console messages prior to the console being
855 initialised to a buffer of size CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ
856 bytes located at CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_ADDR. The buffer is
857 a circular buffer, so if more than CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +0200858 bytes are output before the console is initialised, the
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200859 earlier bytes are discarded.
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000860
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200861 'Sane' compilers will generate smaller code if
862 CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ is a power of 2
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000863
Sonny Rao046a37b2011-11-02 09:52:08 +0000864- Safe printf() functions
865 Define CONFIG_SYS_VSNPRINTF to compile in safe versions of
866 the printf() functions. These are defined in
867 include/vsprintf.h and include snprintf(), vsnprintf() and
868 so on. Code size increase is approximately 300-500 bytes.
869 If this option is not given then these functions will
870 silently discard their buffer size argument - this means
871 you are not getting any overflow checking in this case.
872
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000873- Boot Delay: CONFIG_BOOTDELAY - in seconds
874 Delay before automatically booting the default image;
875 set to -1 to disable autoboot.
Joe Hershberger93d72122012-08-17 10:53:12 +0000876 set to -2 to autoboot with no delay and not check for abort
877 (even when CONFIG_ZERO_BOOTDELAY_CHECK is defined).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000878
879 See doc/README.autoboot for these options that
880 work with CONFIG_BOOTDELAY. None are required.
881 CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
882 CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_MIN
883 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_KEYED
884 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_PROMPT
885 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
886 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
887 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR2
888 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR2
889 CONFIG_ZERO_BOOTDELAY_CHECK
890 CONFIG_RESET_TO_RETRY
891
892- Autoboot Command:
893 CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
894 Only needed when CONFIG_BOOTDELAY is enabled;
895 define a command string that is automatically executed
896 when no character is read on the console interface
897 within "Boot Delay" after reset.
898
899 CONFIG_BOOTARGS
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000900 This can be used to pass arguments to the bootm
901 command. The value of CONFIG_BOOTARGS goes into the
902 environment value "bootargs".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000903
904 CONFIG_RAMBOOT and CONFIG_NFSBOOT
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000905 The value of these goes into the environment as
906 "ramboot" and "nfsboot" respectively, and can be used
907 as a convenience, when switching between booting from
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200908 RAM and NFS.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000909
Heiko Schochereda0ba32013-11-04 14:04:59 +0100910- Bootcount:
911 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_LIMIT
912 Implements a mechanism for detecting a repeating reboot
913 cycle, see:
914 http://www.denx.de/wiki/view/DULG/UBootBootCountLimit
915
916 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_ENV
917 If no softreset save registers are found on the hardware
918 "bootcount" is stored in the environment. To prevent a
919 saveenv on all reboots, the environment variable
920 "upgrade_available" is used. If "upgrade_available" is
921 0, "bootcount" is always 0, if "upgrade_available" is
922 1 "bootcount" is incremented in the environment.
923 So the Userspace Applikation must set the "upgrade_available"
924 and "bootcount" variable to 0, if a boot was successfully.
925
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000926- Pre-Boot Commands:
927 CONFIG_PREBOOT
928
929 When this option is #defined, the existence of the
930 environment variable "preboot" will be checked
931 immediately before starting the CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
932 countdown and/or running the auto-boot command resp.
933 entering interactive mode.
934
935 This feature is especially useful when "preboot" is
936 automatically generated or modified. For an example
937 see the LWMON board specific code: here "preboot" is
938 modified when the user holds down a certain
939 combination of keys on the (special) keyboard when
940 booting the systems
941
942- Serial Download Echo Mode:
943 CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
944 If defined to 1, all characters received during a
945 serial download (using the "loads" command) are
946 echoed back. This might be needed by some terminal
947 emulations (like "cu"), but may as well just take
948 time on others. This setting #define's the initial
949 value of the "loads_echo" environment variable.
950
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500951- Kgdb Serial Baudrate: (if CONFIG_CMD_KGDB is defined)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000952 CONFIG_KGDB_BAUDRATE
953 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200954 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000955
956- Monitor Functions:
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500957 Monitor commands can be included or excluded
958 from the build by using the #include files
Stephen Warrenc6c621b2012-08-05 16:07:19 +0000959 <config_cmd_all.h> and #undef'ing unwanted
960 commands, or using <config_cmd_default.h>
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500961 and augmenting with additional #define's
962 for wanted commands.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000963
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500964 The default command configuration includes all commands
965 except those marked below with a "*".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000966
Marek Vasutb401b732014-03-05 19:58:39 +0100967 CONFIG_CMD_AES AES 128 CBC encrypt/decrypt
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500968 CONFIG_CMD_ASKENV * ask for env variable
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500969 CONFIG_CMD_BDI bdinfo
970 CONFIG_CMD_BEDBUG * Include BedBug Debugger
971 CONFIG_CMD_BMP * BMP support
972 CONFIG_CMD_BSP * Board specific commands
973 CONFIG_CMD_BOOTD bootd
Tom Rinid2b2ffe2014-08-14 06:42:36 -0400974 CONFIG_CMD_BOOTI * ARM64 Linux kernel Image support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500975 CONFIG_CMD_CACHE * icache, dcache
Michal Simek08d0d6f2013-11-21 13:39:02 -0800976 CONFIG_CMD_CLK * clock command support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500977 CONFIG_CMD_CONSOLE coninfo
Mike Frysinger710b9932010-12-21 14:19:51 -0500978 CONFIG_CMD_CRC32 * crc32
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500979 CONFIG_CMD_DATE * support for RTC, date/time...
980 CONFIG_CMD_DHCP * DHCP support
981 CONFIG_CMD_DIAG * Diagnostics
Peter Tysera7c93102008-12-17 16:36:22 -0600982 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510 * ds4510 I2C gpio commands
983 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_INFO * ds4510 I2C info command
984 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_MEM * ds4510 I2C eeprom/sram commansd
985 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_RST * ds4510 I2C rst command
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500986 CONFIG_CMD_DTT * Digital Therm and Thermostat
987 CONFIG_CMD_ECHO echo arguments
Peter Tyser246c6922009-10-25 15:12:56 -0500988 CONFIG_CMD_EDITENV edit env variable
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500989 CONFIG_CMD_EEPROM * EEPROM read/write support
990 CONFIG_CMD_ELF * bootelf, bootvx
Joe Hershberger5e2b3e02012-12-11 22:16:25 -0600991 CONFIG_CMD_ENV_CALLBACK * display details about env callbacks
Joe Hershbergerfffad712012-12-11 22:16:33 -0600992 CONFIG_CMD_ENV_FLAGS * display details about env flags
Andrew Ruder88733e22013-10-22 19:07:34 -0500993 CONFIG_CMD_ENV_EXISTS * check existence of env variable
Mike Frysinger0c79cda2010-12-26 23:09:45 -0500994 CONFIG_CMD_EXPORTENV * export the environment
Stephen Warren03e2ecf2012-10-22 06:43:50 +0000995 CONFIG_CMD_EXT2 * ext2 command support
996 CONFIG_CMD_EXT4 * ext4 command support
Stephen Warren16f4d932014-01-24 20:46:37 -0700997 CONFIG_CMD_FS_GENERIC * filesystem commands (e.g. load, ls)
998 that work for multiple fs types
Mike Frysingerbdab39d2009-01-28 19:08:14 -0500999 CONFIG_CMD_SAVEENV saveenv
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001000 CONFIG_CMD_FDC * Floppy Disk Support
Stephen Warren03e2ecf2012-10-22 06:43:50 +00001001 CONFIG_CMD_FAT * FAT command support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001002 CONFIG_CMD_FLASH flinfo, erase, protect
1003 CONFIG_CMD_FPGA FPGA device initialization support
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001004 CONFIG_CMD_FUSE * Device fuse support
Anton Staaf53fdc7e2012-12-05 14:46:29 +00001005 CONFIG_CMD_GETTIME * Get time since boot
Mike Frysingera641b972010-12-26 23:32:22 -05001006 CONFIG_CMD_GO * the 'go' command (exec code)
Kim Phillipsa000b792011-04-05 07:15:14 +00001007 CONFIG_CMD_GREPENV * search environment
Simon Glassbf36c5d2012-12-05 14:46:38 +00001008 CONFIG_CMD_HASH * calculate hash / digest
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001009 CONFIG_CMD_HWFLOW * RTS/CTS hw flow control
1010 CONFIG_CMD_I2C * I2C serial bus support
1011 CONFIG_CMD_IDE * IDE harddisk support
1012 CONFIG_CMD_IMI iminfo
Vipin Kumar8fdf1e02012-12-16 22:32:48 +00001013 CONFIG_CMD_IMLS List all images found in NOR flash
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001014 CONFIG_CMD_IMLS_NAND * List all images found in NAND flash
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001015 CONFIG_CMD_IMMAP * IMMR dump support
Simon Glassaa532332014-06-11 23:29:41 -06001016 CONFIG_CMD_IOTRACE * I/O tracing for debugging
Mike Frysinger0c79cda2010-12-26 23:09:45 -05001017 CONFIG_CMD_IMPORTENV * import an environment
Joe Hershbergerc167cc02012-10-03 11:15:51 +00001018 CONFIG_CMD_INI * import data from an ini file into the env
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001019 CONFIG_CMD_IRQ * irqinfo
1020 CONFIG_CMD_ITEST Integer/string test of 2 values
1021 CONFIG_CMD_JFFS2 * JFFS2 Support
1022 CONFIG_CMD_KGDB * kgdb
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001023 CONFIG_CMD_LDRINFO * ldrinfo (display Blackfin loader)
Joe Hershbergerd22c3382012-05-23 08:00:12 +00001024 CONFIG_CMD_LINK_LOCAL * link-local IP address auto-configuration
1025 (169.254.*.*)
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001026 CONFIG_CMD_LOADB loadb
1027 CONFIG_CMD_LOADS loads
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001028 CONFIG_CMD_MD5SUM * print md5 message digest
Robin Getz02c9aa12009-07-27 00:07:59 -04001029 (requires CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY and CONFIG_MD5)
Simon Glass15a33e42012-11-30 13:01:20 +00001030 CONFIG_CMD_MEMINFO * Display detailed memory information
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001031 CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY md, mm, nm, mw, cp, cmp, crc, base,
Wolfgang Denka2681702013-03-08 10:51:32 +00001032 loop, loopw
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001033 CONFIG_CMD_MEMTEST * mtest
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001034 CONFIG_CMD_MISC Misc functions like sleep etc
1035 CONFIG_CMD_MMC * MMC memory mapped support
1036 CONFIG_CMD_MII * MII utility commands
Stefan Roese68d7d652009-03-19 13:30:36 +01001037 CONFIG_CMD_MTDPARTS * MTD partition support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001038 CONFIG_CMD_NAND * NAND support
1039 CONFIG_CMD_NET bootp, tftpboot, rarpboot
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001040 CONFIG_CMD_NFS NFS support
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001041 CONFIG_CMD_PCA953X * PCA953x I2C gpio commands
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00001042 CONFIG_CMD_PCA953X_INFO * PCA953x I2C gpio info command
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001043 CONFIG_CMD_PCI * pciinfo
1044 CONFIG_CMD_PCMCIA * PCMCIA support
1045 CONFIG_CMD_PING * send ICMP ECHO_REQUEST to network
1046 host
1047 CONFIG_CMD_PORTIO * Port I/O
Kenneth Watersff048ea2012-12-05 14:46:30 +00001048 CONFIG_CMD_READ * Read raw data from partition
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001049 CONFIG_CMD_REGINFO * Register dump
1050 CONFIG_CMD_RUN run command in env variable
Simon Glassd3049312012-12-26 09:53:36 +00001051 CONFIG_CMD_SANDBOX * sb command to access sandbox features
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001052 CONFIG_CMD_SAVES * save S record dump
1053 CONFIG_CMD_SCSI * SCSI Support
1054 CONFIG_CMD_SDRAM * print SDRAM configuration information
1055 (requires CONFIG_CMD_I2C)
1056 CONFIG_CMD_SETGETDCR Support for DCR Register access
1057 (4xx only)
Eric Nelsonf61ec452012-01-31 10:52:08 -07001058 CONFIG_CMD_SF * Read/write/erase SPI NOR flash
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001059 CONFIG_CMD_SHA1SUM * print sha1 memory digest
Robin Getz02c9aa12009-07-27 00:07:59 -04001060 (requires CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY)
Bob Liu7d861d92013-02-05 19:05:41 +08001061 CONFIG_CMD_SOFTSWITCH * Soft switch setting command for BF60x
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02001062 CONFIG_CMD_SOURCE "source" command Support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001063 CONFIG_CMD_SPI * SPI serial bus support
Luca Ceresoli7a83af02011-05-17 00:03:40 +00001064 CONFIG_CMD_TFTPSRV * TFTP transfer in server mode
Simon Glass1fb7cd42011-10-24 18:00:07 +00001065 CONFIG_CMD_TFTPPUT * TFTP put command (upload)
Joe Hershbergerda83bcd2012-10-03 12:14:57 +00001066 CONFIG_CMD_TIME * run command and report execution time (ARM specific)
1067 CONFIG_CMD_TIMER * access to the system tick timer
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001068 CONFIG_CMD_USB * USB support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001069 CONFIG_CMD_CDP * Cisco Discover Protocol support
Marek Vasutc8339f52012-03-31 07:47:16 +00001070 CONFIG_CMD_MFSL * Microblaze FSL support
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001071 CONFIG_CMD_XIMG Load part of Multi Image
Przemyslaw Marczak89c82302014-04-02 10:20:05 +02001072 CONFIG_CMD_UUID * Generate random UUID or GUID string
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001073
1074 EXAMPLE: If you want all functions except of network
1075 support you can write:
1076
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001077 #include "config_cmd_all.h"
1078 #undef CONFIG_CMD_NET
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001079
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -04001080 Other Commands:
1081 fdt (flattened device tree) command: CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001082
1083 Note: Don't enable the "icache" and "dcache" commands
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001084 (configuration option CONFIG_CMD_CACHE) unless you know
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001085 what you (and your U-Boot users) are doing. Data
1086 cache cannot be enabled on systems like the 8xx or
1087 8260 (where accesses to the IMMR region must be
1088 uncached), and it cannot be disabled on all other
1089 systems where we (mis-) use the data cache to hold an
1090 initial stack and some data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001091
1092
1093 XXX - this list needs to get updated!
1094
Wolfgang Denka5ecbe62013-03-23 23:50:31 +00001095- Regular expression support:
1096 CONFIG_REGEX
Wolfgang Denk93e14592013-10-04 17:43:24 +02001097 If this variable is defined, U-Boot is linked against
1098 the SLRE (Super Light Regular Expression) library,
1099 which adds regex support to some commands, as for
1100 example "env grep" and "setexpr".
Wolfgang Denka5ecbe62013-03-23 23:50:31 +00001101
Simon Glass45ba8072011-10-15 05:48:20 +00001102- Device tree:
1103 CONFIG_OF_CONTROL
1104 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will use a device tree
1105 to configure its devices, instead of relying on statically
1106 compiled #defines in the board file. This option is
1107 experimental and only available on a few boards. The device
1108 tree is available in the global data as gd->fdt_blob.
1109
Simon Glass2c0f79e2011-10-24 19:15:31 +00001110 U-Boot needs to get its device tree from somewhere. This can
1111 be done using one of the two options below:
Simon Glassbbb0b122011-10-15 05:48:21 +00001112
1113 CONFIG_OF_EMBED
1114 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will embed a device tree
1115 binary in its image. This device tree file should be in the
1116 board directory and called <soc>-<board>.dts. The binary file
1117 is then picked up in board_init_f() and made available through
1118 the global data structure as gd->blob.
Simon Glass45ba8072011-10-15 05:48:20 +00001119
Simon Glass2c0f79e2011-10-24 19:15:31 +00001120 CONFIG_OF_SEPARATE
1121 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will build a device tree
1122 binary. It will be called u-boot.dtb. Architecture-specific
1123 code will locate it at run-time. Generally this works by:
1124
1125 cat u-boot.bin u-boot.dtb >image.bin
1126
1127 and in fact, U-Boot does this for you, creating a file called
1128 u-boot-dtb.bin which is useful in the common case. You can
1129 still use the individual files if you need something more
1130 exotic.
1131
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001132- Watchdog:
1133 CONFIG_WATCHDOG
1134 If this variable is defined, it enables watchdog
Detlev Zundel6abe6fb2011-04-27 05:25:59 +00001135 support for the SoC. There must be support in the SoC
1136 specific code for a watchdog. For the 8xx and 8260
1137 CPUs, the SIU Watchdog feature is enabled in the SYPCR
1138 register. When supported for a specific SoC is
1139 available, then no further board specific code should
1140 be needed to use it.
1141
1142 CONFIG_HW_WATCHDOG
1143 When using a watchdog circuitry external to the used
1144 SoC, then define this variable and provide board
1145 specific code for the "hw_watchdog_reset" function.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001146
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00001147- U-Boot Version:
1148 CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE
1149 If this variable is defined, an environment variable
1150 named "ver" is created by U-Boot showing the U-Boot
1151 version as printed by the "version" command.
Benoît Thébaudeaua1ea8e52012-08-13 15:01:14 +02001152 Any change to this variable will be reverted at the
1153 next reset.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00001154
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001155- Real-Time Clock:
1156
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001157 When CONFIG_CMD_DATE is selected, the type of the RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001158 has to be selected, too. Define exactly one of the
1159 following options:
1160
1161 CONFIG_RTC_MPC8xx - use internal RTC of MPC8xx
1162 CONFIG_RTC_PCF8563 - use Philips PCF8563 RTC
Fabio Estevam4e8b7542011-10-24 06:44:15 +00001163 CONFIG_RTC_MC13XXX - use MC13783 or MC13892 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001164 CONFIG_RTC_MC146818 - use MC146818 RTC
wdenk1cb8e982003-03-06 21:55:29 +00001165 CONFIG_RTC_DS1307 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1307 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001166 CONFIG_RTC_DS1337 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1337 RTC
wdenk7f70e852003-05-20 14:25:27 +00001167 CONFIG_RTC_DS1338 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1338 RTC
Markus Niebel412921d2014-07-21 11:06:16 +02001168 CONFIG_RTC_DS1339 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1339 RTC
wdenk3bac3512003-03-12 10:41:04 +00001169 CONFIG_RTC_DS164x - use Dallas DS164x RTC
Tor Krill9536dfc2008-03-15 15:40:26 +01001170 CONFIG_RTC_ISL1208 - use Intersil ISL1208 RTC
wdenk4c0d4c32004-06-09 17:34:58 +00001171 CONFIG_RTC_MAX6900 - use Maxim, Inc. MAX6900 RTC
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001172 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_DS1337_NOOSC - Turn off the OSC output for DS1337
Heiko Schocher71d19f32011-03-28 09:24:22 +02001173 CONFIG_SYS_RV3029_TCR - enable trickle charger on
1174 RV3029 RTC.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001175
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001176 Note that if the RTC uses I2C, then the I2C interface
1177 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
1178
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001179- GPIO Support:
1180 CONFIG_PCA953X - use NXP's PCA953X series I2C GPIO
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001181
Chris Packham5dec49c2010-12-19 10:12:13 +00001182 The CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PCA953X_WIDTH option specifies a list of
1183 chip-ngpio pairs that tell the PCA953X driver the number of
1184 pins supported by a particular chip.
1185
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001186 Note that if the GPIO device uses I2C, then the I2C interface
1187 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
1188
Simon Glassaa532332014-06-11 23:29:41 -06001189- I/O tracing:
1190 When CONFIG_IO_TRACE is selected, U-Boot intercepts all I/O
1191 accesses and can checksum them or write a list of them out
1192 to memory. See the 'iotrace' command for details. This is
1193 useful for testing device drivers since it can confirm that
1194 the driver behaves the same way before and after a code
1195 change. Currently this is supported on sandbox and arm. To
1196 add support for your architecture, add '#include <iotrace.h>'
1197 to the bottom of arch/<arch>/include/asm/io.h and test.
1198
1199 Example output from the 'iotrace stats' command is below.
1200 Note that if the trace buffer is exhausted, the checksum will
1201 still continue to operate.
1202
1203 iotrace is enabled
1204 Start: 10000000 (buffer start address)
1205 Size: 00010000 (buffer size)
1206 Offset: 00000120 (current buffer offset)
1207 Output: 10000120 (start + offset)
1208 Count: 00000018 (number of trace records)
1209 CRC32: 9526fb66 (CRC32 of all trace records)
1210
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001211- Timestamp Support:
1212
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001213 When CONFIG_TIMESTAMP is selected, the timestamp
1214 (date and time) of an image is printed by image
1215 commands like bootm or iminfo. This option is
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001216 automatically enabled when you select CONFIG_CMD_DATE .
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001217
Karl O. Pinc923c46f2012-08-16 06:20:15 +00001218- Partition Labels (disklabels) Supported:
1219 Zero or more of the following:
1220 CONFIG_MAC_PARTITION Apple's MacOS partition table.
1221 CONFIG_DOS_PARTITION MS Dos partition table, traditional on the
1222 Intel architecture, USB sticks, etc.
1223 CONFIG_ISO_PARTITION ISO partition table, used on CDROM etc.
1224 CONFIG_EFI_PARTITION GPT partition table, common when EFI is the
1225 bootloader. Note 2TB partition limit; see
1226 disk/part_efi.c
1227 CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS Memory Technology Device partition table.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001228
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01001229 If IDE or SCSI support is enabled (CONFIG_CMD_IDE or
1230 CONFIG_CMD_SCSI) you must configure support for at
Karl O. Pinc923c46f2012-08-16 06:20:15 +00001231 least one non-MTD partition type as well.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001232
1233- IDE Reset method:
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001234 CONFIG_IDE_RESET_ROUTINE - this is defined in several
1235 board configurations files but used nowhere!
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001236
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001237 CONFIG_IDE_RESET - is this is defined, IDE Reset will
1238 be performed by calling the function
1239 ide_set_reset(int reset)
1240 which has to be defined in a board specific file
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001241
1242- ATAPI Support:
1243 CONFIG_ATAPI
1244
1245 Set this to enable ATAPI support.
1246
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001247- LBA48 Support
1248 CONFIG_LBA48
1249
1250 Set this to enable support for disks larger than 137GB
Heiko Schocher4b142fe2009-12-03 11:21:21 +01001251 Also look at CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA.
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001252 Whithout these , LBA48 support uses 32bit variables and will 'only'
1253 support disks up to 2.1TB.
1254
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001255 CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA:
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001256 When enabled, makes the IDE subsystem use 64bit sector addresses.
1257 Default is 32bit.
1258
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001259- SCSI Support:
1260 At the moment only there is only support for the
1261 SYM53C8XX SCSI controller; define
1262 CONFIG_SCSI_SYM53C8XX to enable it.
1263
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001264 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN [8], CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID [7] and
1265 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_DEVICE [CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID *
1266 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN] can be adjusted to define the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001267 maximum numbers of LUNs, SCSI ID's and target
1268 devices.
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001269 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_SYM53C8XX_CCF to fix clock timing (80Mhz)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001270
Wolfgang Denk93e14592013-10-04 17:43:24 +02001271 The environment variable 'scsidevs' is set to the number of
1272 SCSI devices found during the last scan.
Stefan Reinauer447c0312012-10-29 05:23:48 +00001273
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001274- NETWORK Support (PCI):
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001275 CONFIG_E1000
Kyle Moffettce5207e2011-10-18 11:05:29 +00001276 Support for Intel 8254x/8257x gigabit chips.
1277
1278 CONFIG_E1000_SPI
1279 Utility code for direct access to the SPI bus on Intel 8257x.
1280 This does not do anything useful unless you set at least one
1281 of CONFIG_CMD_E1000 or CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC.
1282
1283 CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC
1284 Allow generic access to the SPI bus on the Intel 8257x, for
1285 example with the "sspi" command.
1286
1287 CONFIG_CMD_E1000
1288 Management command for E1000 devices. When used on devices
1289 with SPI support you can reprogram the EEPROM from U-Boot.
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00001290
Andre Schwarzac3315c2008-03-06 16:45:44 +01001291 CONFIG_E1000_FALLBACK_MAC
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001292 default MAC for empty EEPROM after production.
Andre Schwarzac3315c2008-03-06 16:45:44 +01001293
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001294 CONFIG_EEPRO100
1295 Support for Intel 82557/82559/82559ER chips.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001296 Optional CONFIG_EEPRO100_SROM_WRITE enables EEPROM
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001297 write routine for first time initialisation.
1298
1299 CONFIG_TULIP
1300 Support for Digital 2114x chips.
1301 Optional CONFIG_TULIP_SELECT_MEDIA for board specific
1302 modem chip initialisation (KS8761/QS6611).
1303
1304 CONFIG_NATSEMI
1305 Support for National dp83815 chips.
1306
1307 CONFIG_NS8382X
1308 Support for National dp8382[01] gigabit chips.
1309
wdenk45219c42003-05-12 21:50:16 +00001310- NETWORK Support (other):
1311
Jens Scharsigc041e9d2010-01-23 12:03:45 +01001312 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC
1313 Support for AT91RM9200 EMAC.
1314
1315 CONFIG_RMII
1316 Define this to use reduced MII inteface
1317
1318 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC_QUIET
1319 If this defined, the driver is quiet.
1320 The driver doen't show link status messages.
1321
Rob Herringefdd7312011-12-15 11:15:49 +00001322 CONFIG_CALXEDA_XGMAC
1323 Support for the Calxeda XGMAC device
1324
Ashok3bb46d22012-10-15 06:20:47 +00001325 CONFIG_LAN91C96
wdenk45219c42003-05-12 21:50:16 +00001326 Support for SMSC's LAN91C96 chips.
1327
1328 CONFIG_LAN91C96_BASE
1329 Define this to hold the physical address
1330 of the LAN91C96's I/O space
1331
1332 CONFIG_LAN91C96_USE_32_BIT
1333 Define this to enable 32 bit addressing
1334
Ashok3bb46d22012-10-15 06:20:47 +00001335 CONFIG_SMC91111
wdenkf39748a2004-06-09 13:37:52 +00001336 Support for SMSC's LAN91C111 chip
1337
1338 CONFIG_SMC91111_BASE
1339 Define this to hold the physical address
1340 of the device (I/O space)
1341
1342 CONFIG_SMC_USE_32_BIT
1343 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
1344
1345 CONFIG_SMC_USE_IOFUNCS
1346 Define this to use i/o functions instead of macros
1347 (some hardware wont work with macros)
1348
Heiko Schocherdc02bad2011-11-15 10:00:04 -05001349 CONFIG_DRIVER_TI_EMAC
1350 Support for davinci emac
1351
1352 CONFIG_SYS_DAVINCI_EMAC_PHY_COUNT
1353 Define this if you have more then 3 PHYs.
1354
Macpaul Linb3dbf4a52010-12-21 16:59:46 +08001355 CONFIG_FTGMAC100
1356 Support for Faraday's FTGMAC100 Gigabit SoC Ethernet
1357
1358 CONFIG_FTGMAC100_EGIGA
1359 Define this to use GE link update with gigabit PHY.
1360 Define this if FTGMAC100 is connected to gigabit PHY.
1361 If your system has 10/100 PHY only, it might not occur
1362 wrong behavior. Because PHY usually return timeout or
1363 useless data when polling gigabit status and gigabit
1364 control registers. This behavior won't affect the
1365 correctnessof 10/100 link speed update.
1366
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001367 CONFIG_SMC911X
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001368 Support for SMSC's LAN911x and LAN921x chips
1369
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001370 CONFIG_SMC911X_BASE
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001371 Define this to hold the physical address
1372 of the device (I/O space)
1373
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001374 CONFIG_SMC911X_32_BIT
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001375 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
1376
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001377 CONFIG_SMC911X_16_BIT
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001378 Define this if data bus is 16 bits. If your processor
1379 automatically converts one 32 bit word to two 16 bit
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001380 words you may also try CONFIG_SMC911X_32_BIT.
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001381
Yoshihiro Shimoda3d0075f2011-01-27 10:06:03 +09001382 CONFIG_SH_ETHER
1383 Support for Renesas on-chip Ethernet controller
1384
1385 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_USE_PORT
1386 Define the number of ports to be used
1387
1388 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_PHY_ADDR
1389 Define the ETH PHY's address
1390
Yoshihiro Shimoda68260aa2011-01-27 10:06:08 +09001391 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_CACHE_WRITEBACK
1392 If this option is set, the driver enables cache flush.
1393
Heiko Schocherb2f97cf2014-07-18 06:07:19 +02001394- PWM Support:
1395 CONFIG_PWM_IMX
1396 Support for PWM modul on the imx6.
1397
Vadim Bendebury5e124722011-10-17 08:36:14 +00001398- TPM Support:
Che-liang Chiou90899cc2013-04-12 11:04:34 +00001399 CONFIG_TPM
1400 Support TPM devices.
1401
Tom Wai-Hong Tam1b393db2013-04-12 11:04:37 +00001402 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_I2C
1403 Support for i2c bus TPM devices. Only one device
1404 per system is supported at this time.
1405
1406 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_I2C_BUS_NUMBER
1407 Define the the i2c bus number for the TPM device
1408
1409 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_I2C_SLAVE_ADDRESS
1410 Define the TPM's address on the i2c bus
1411
1412 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_I2C_BURST_LIMITATION
1413 Define the burst count bytes upper limit
1414
Dirk Eibachc01939c2013-06-26 15:55:15 +02001415 CONFIG_TPM_ATMEL_TWI
1416 Support for Atmel TWI TPM device. Requires I2C support.
1417
Che-liang Chiou90899cc2013-04-12 11:04:34 +00001418 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_LPC
Vadim Bendebury5e124722011-10-17 08:36:14 +00001419 Support for generic parallel port TPM devices. Only one device
1420 per system is supported at this time.
1421
1422 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_BASE_ADDRESS
1423 Base address where the generic TPM device is mapped
1424 to. Contemporary x86 systems usually map it at
1425 0xfed40000.
1426
Reinhard Pfaube6c1522013-06-26 15:55:13 +02001427 CONFIG_CMD_TPM
1428 Add tpm monitor functions.
1429 Requires CONFIG_TPM. If CONFIG_TPM_AUTH_SESSIONS is set, also
1430 provides monitor access to authorized functions.
1431
1432 CONFIG_TPM
1433 Define this to enable the TPM support library which provides
1434 functional interfaces to some TPM commands.
1435 Requires support for a TPM device.
1436
1437 CONFIG_TPM_AUTH_SESSIONS
1438 Define this to enable authorized functions in the TPM library.
1439 Requires CONFIG_TPM and CONFIG_SHA1.
1440
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001441- USB Support:
1442 At the moment only the UHCI host controller is
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001443 supported (PIP405, MIP405, MPC5200); define
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001444 CONFIG_USB_UHCI to enable it.
1445 define CONFIG_USB_KEYBOARD to enable the USB Keyboard
wdenk30d56fa2004-10-09 22:44:59 +00001446 and define CONFIG_USB_STORAGE to enable the USB
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001447 storage devices.
1448 Note:
1449 Supported are USB Keyboards and USB Floppy drives
1450 (TEAC FD-05PUB).
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001451 MPC5200 USB requires additional defines:
1452 CONFIG_USB_CLOCK
1453 for 528 MHz Clock: 0x0001bbbb
Eric Millbrandt307ecb62009-08-13 08:32:37 -05001454 CONFIG_PSC3_USB
1455 for USB on PSC3
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001456 CONFIG_USB_CONFIG
1457 for differential drivers: 0x00001000
1458 for single ended drivers: 0x00005000
Eric Millbrandt307ecb62009-08-13 08:32:37 -05001459 for differential drivers on PSC3: 0x00000100
1460 for single ended drivers on PSC3: 0x00004100
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001461 CONFIG_SYS_USB_EVENT_POLL
Zhang Weifdcfaa12007-06-06 10:08:13 +02001462 May be defined to allow interrupt polling
1463 instead of using asynchronous interrupts
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001464
Simon Glass9ab4ce22012-02-27 10:52:47 +00001465 CONFIG_USB_EHCI_TXFIFO_THRESH enables setting of the
1466 txfilltuning field in the EHCI controller on reset.
1467
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001468- USB Device:
1469 Define the below if you wish to use the USB console.
1470 Once firmware is rebuilt from a serial console issue the
1471 command "setenv stdin usbtty; setenv stdout usbtty" and
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001472 attach your USB cable. The Unix command "dmesg" should print
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001473 it has found a new device. The environment variable usbtty
1474 can be set to gserial or cdc_acm to enable your device to
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001475 appear to a USB host as a Linux gserial device or a
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001476 Common Device Class Abstract Control Model serial device.
1477 If you select usbtty = gserial you should be able to enumerate
1478 a Linux host by
1479 # modprobe usbserial vendor=0xVendorID product=0xProductID
1480 else if using cdc_acm, simply setting the environment
1481 variable usbtty to be cdc_acm should suffice. The following
1482 might be defined in YourBoardName.h
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001483
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001484 CONFIG_USB_DEVICE
1485 Define this to build a UDC device
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001486
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001487 CONFIG_USB_TTY
1488 Define this to have a tty type of device available to
1489 talk to the UDC device
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001490
Vipin KUMARf9da0f82012-03-26 15:38:06 +05301491 CONFIG_USBD_HS
1492 Define this to enable the high speed support for usb
1493 device and usbtty. If this feature is enabled, a routine
1494 int is_usbd_high_speed(void)
1495 also needs to be defined by the driver to dynamically poll
1496 whether the enumeration has succeded at high speed or full
1497 speed.
1498
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001499 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001500 Define this if you want stdin, stdout &/or stderr to
1501 be set to usbtty.
1502
1503 mpc8xx:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001504 CONFIG_SYS_USB_EXTC_CLK 0xBLAH
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001505 Derive USB clock from external clock "blah"
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001506 - CONFIG_SYS_USB_EXTC_CLK 0x02
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001507
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001508 CONFIG_SYS_USB_BRG_CLK 0xBLAH
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001509 Derive USB clock from brgclk
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001510 - CONFIG_SYS_USB_BRG_CLK 0x04
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001511
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001512 If you have a USB-IF assigned VendorID then you may wish to
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001513 define your own vendor specific values either in BoardName.h
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001514 or directly in usbd_vendor_info.h. If you don't define
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001515 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER, CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME,
1516 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID and CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID, then U-Boot
1517 should pretend to be a Linux device to it's target host.
1518
1519 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER
1520 Define this string as the name of your company for
1521 - CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER "my company"
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001522
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001523 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME
1524 Define this string as the name of your product
1525 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME "acme usb device"
1526
1527 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID
1528 Define this as your assigned Vendor ID from the USB
1529 Implementors Forum. This *must* be a genuine Vendor ID
1530 to avoid polluting the USB namespace.
1531 - CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID 0xFFFF
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001532
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001533 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID
1534 Define this as the unique Product ID
1535 for your device
1536 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID 0xFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001537
Igor Grinbergd70a5602011-12-12 12:08:35 +02001538- ULPI Layer Support:
1539 The ULPI (UTMI Low Pin (count) Interface) PHYs are supported via
1540 the generic ULPI layer. The generic layer accesses the ULPI PHY
1541 via the platform viewport, so you need both the genric layer and
1542 the viewport enabled. Currently only Chipidea/ARC based
1543 viewport is supported.
1544 To enable the ULPI layer support, define CONFIG_USB_ULPI and
1545 CONFIG_USB_ULPI_VIEWPORT in your board configuration file.
Lucas Stach6d365ea2012-10-01 00:44:35 +02001546 If your ULPI phy needs a different reference clock than the
1547 standard 24 MHz then you have to define CONFIG_ULPI_REF_CLK to
1548 the appropriate value in Hz.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001549
1550- MMC Support:
1551 The MMC controller on the Intel PXA is supported. To
1552 enable this define CONFIG_MMC. The MMC can be
1553 accessed from the boot prompt by mapping the device
1554 to physical memory similar to flash. Command line is
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001555 enabled with CONFIG_CMD_MMC. The MMC driver also works with
1556 the FAT fs. This is enabled with CONFIG_CMD_FAT.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001557
Yoshihiro Shimodaafb35662011-07-04 22:21:22 +00001558 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF
1559 Support for Renesas on-chip MMCIF controller
1560
1561 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_ADDR
1562 Define the base address of MMCIF registers
1563
1564 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_CLK
1565 Define the clock frequency for MMCIF
1566
Pierre Aubert1fd93c62014-04-24 10:30:08 +02001567 CONFIG_GENERIC_MMC
1568 Enable the generic MMC driver
1569
1570 CONFIG_SUPPORT_EMMC_BOOT
1571 Enable some additional features of the eMMC boot partitions.
1572
1573 CONFIG_SUPPORT_EMMC_RPMB
1574 Enable the commands for reading, writing and programming the
1575 key for the Replay Protection Memory Block partition in eMMC.
1576
Tom Rinib3ba6e92013-03-14 05:32:47 +00001577- USB Device Firmware Update (DFU) class support:
1578 CONFIG_DFU_FUNCTION
1579 This enables the USB portion of the DFU USB class
1580
1581 CONFIG_CMD_DFU
1582 This enables the command "dfu" which is used to have
1583 U-Boot create a DFU class device via USB. This command
1584 requires that the "dfu_alt_info" environment variable be
1585 set and define the alt settings to expose to the host.
1586
1587 CONFIG_DFU_MMC
1588 This enables support for exposing (e)MMC devices via DFU.
1589
Pantelis Antoniouc6631762013-03-14 05:32:52 +00001590 CONFIG_DFU_NAND
1591 This enables support for exposing NAND devices via DFU.
1592
Afzal Mohammeda9479f02013-09-18 01:15:24 +05301593 CONFIG_DFU_RAM
1594 This enables support for exposing RAM via DFU.
1595 Note: DFU spec refer to non-volatile memory usage, but
1596 allow usages beyond the scope of spec - here RAM usage,
1597 one that would help mostly the developer.
1598
Heiko Schochere7e75c72013-06-12 06:05:51 +02001599 CONFIG_SYS_DFU_DATA_BUF_SIZE
1600 Dfu transfer uses a buffer before writing data to the
1601 raw storage device. Make the size (in bytes) of this buffer
1602 configurable. The size of this buffer is also configurable
1603 through the "dfu_bufsiz" environment variable.
1604
Pantelis Antoniouea2453d2013-03-14 05:32:48 +00001605 CONFIG_SYS_DFU_MAX_FILE_SIZE
1606 When updating files rather than the raw storage device,
1607 we use a static buffer to copy the file into and then write
1608 the buffer once we've been given the whole file. Define
1609 this to the maximum filesize (in bytes) for the buffer.
1610 Default is 4 MiB if undefined.
1611
Heiko Schocher001a8312014-03-18 08:09:56 +01001612 DFU_DEFAULT_POLL_TIMEOUT
1613 Poll timeout [ms], is the timeout a device can send to the
1614 host. The host must wait for this timeout before sending
1615 a subsequent DFU_GET_STATUS request to the device.
1616
1617 DFU_MANIFEST_POLL_TIMEOUT
1618 Poll timeout [ms], which the device sends to the host when
1619 entering dfuMANIFEST state. Host waits this timeout, before
1620 sending again an USB request to the device.
1621
Sebastian Siewior3aab70a2014-05-05 15:08:10 -05001622- USB Device Android Fastboot support:
1623 CONFIG_CMD_FASTBOOT
1624 This enables the command "fastboot" which enables the Android
1625 fastboot mode for the platform's USB device. Fastboot is a USB
1626 protocol for downloading images, flashing and device control
1627 used on Android devices.
1628 See doc/README.android-fastboot for more information.
1629
1630 CONFIG_ANDROID_BOOT_IMAGE
1631 This enables support for booting images which use the Android
1632 image format header.
1633
1634 CONFIG_USB_FASTBOOT_BUF_ADDR
1635 The fastboot protocol requires a large memory buffer for
1636 downloads. Define this to the starting RAM address to use for
1637 downloaded images.
1638
1639 CONFIG_USB_FASTBOOT_BUF_SIZE
1640 The fastboot protocol requires a large memory buffer for
1641 downloads. This buffer should be as large as possible for a
1642 platform. Define this to the size available RAM for fastboot.
1643
Steve Raed1b5ed02014-08-26 11:47:28 -07001644 CONFIG_FASTBOOT_FLASH
1645 The fastboot protocol includes a "flash" command for writing
1646 the downloaded image to a non-volatile storage device. Define
1647 this to enable the "fastboot flash" command.
1648
1649 CONFIG_FASTBOOT_FLASH_MMC_DEV
1650 The fastboot "flash" command requires additional information
1651 regarding the non-volatile storage device. Define this to
1652 the eMMC device that fastboot should use to store the image.
1653
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001654- Journaling Flash filesystem support:
1655 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND, CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_OFF, CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_SIZE,
1656 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_DEV
1657 Define these for a default partition on a NAND device
1658
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001659 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_SECTOR,
1660 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_BANK, CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_NUM_BANKS
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001661 Define these for a default partition on a NOR device
1662
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001663 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS_CUSTOM_PART
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001664 Define this to create an own partition. You have to provide a
1665 function struct part_info* jffs2_part_info(int part_num)
1666
1667 If you define only one JFFS2 partition you may also want to
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001668 #define CONFIG_SYS_JFFS_SINGLE_PART 1
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001669 to disable the command chpart. This is the default when you
1670 have not defined a custom partition
1671
Donggeun Kimc30a15e2011-10-24 21:15:28 +00001672- FAT(File Allocation Table) filesystem write function support:
1673 CONFIG_FAT_WRITE
Donggeun Kim656f4c62012-03-22 04:38:56 +00001674
1675 Define this to enable support for saving memory data as a
1676 file in FAT formatted partition.
1677
1678 This will also enable the command "fatwrite" enabling the
1679 user to write files to FAT.
Donggeun Kimc30a15e2011-10-24 21:15:28 +00001680
Gabe Black84cd9322012-10-12 14:26:11 +00001681CBFS (Coreboot Filesystem) support
1682 CONFIG_CMD_CBFS
1683
1684 Define this to enable support for reading from a Coreboot
1685 filesystem. Available commands are cbfsinit, cbfsinfo, cbfsls
1686 and cbfsload.
1687
Siva Durga Prasad Paladugu4f0d1a22014-05-26 19:18:37 +05301688- FAT(File Allocation Table) filesystem cluster size:
1689 CONFIG_FS_FAT_MAX_CLUSTSIZE
1690
1691 Define the max cluster size for fat operations else
1692 a default value of 65536 will be defined.
1693
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001694- Keyboard Support:
1695 CONFIG_ISA_KEYBOARD
1696
1697 Define this to enable standard (PC-Style) keyboard
1698 support
1699
1700 CONFIG_I8042_KBD
1701 Standard PC keyboard driver with US (is default) and
1702 GERMAN key layout (switch via environment 'keymap=de') support.
1703 Export function i8042_kbd_init, i8042_tstc and i8042_getc
1704 for cfb_console. Supports cursor blinking.
1705
Hung-ying Tyan713cb682013-05-15 18:27:32 +08001706 CONFIG_CROS_EC_KEYB
1707 Enables a Chrome OS keyboard using the CROS_EC interface.
1708 This uses CROS_EC to communicate with a second microcontroller
1709 which provides key scans on request.
1710
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001711- Video support:
1712 CONFIG_VIDEO
1713
1714 Define this to enable video support (for output to
1715 video).
1716
1717 CONFIG_VIDEO_CT69000
1718
1719 Enable Chips & Technologies 69000 Video chip
1720
1721 CONFIG_VIDEO_SMI_LYNXEM
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001722 Enable Silicon Motion SMI 712/710/810 Video chip. The
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001723 video output is selected via environment 'videoout'
1724 (1 = LCD and 2 = CRT). If videoout is undefined, CRT is
1725 assumed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001726
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001727 For the CT69000 and SMI_LYNXEM drivers, videomode is
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001728 selected via environment 'videomode'. Two different ways
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001729 are possible:
1730 - "videomode=num" 'num' is a standard LiLo mode numbers.
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00001731 Following standard modes are supported (* is default):
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001732
1733 Colors 640x480 800x600 1024x768 1152x864 1280x1024
1734 -------------+---------------------------------------------
1735 8 bits | 0x301* 0x303 0x305 0x161 0x307
1736 15 bits | 0x310 0x313 0x316 0x162 0x319
1737 16 bits | 0x311 0x314 0x317 0x163 0x31A
1738 24 bits | 0x312 0x315 0x318 ? 0x31B
1739 -------------+---------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001740 (i.e. setenv videomode 317; saveenv; reset;)
1741
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001742 - "videomode=bootargs" all the video parameters are parsed
Marcel Ziswiler7817cb22007-12-30 03:30:46 +01001743 from the bootargs. (See drivers/video/videomodes.c)
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001744
1745
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00001746 CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001747 Enable Epson SED13806 driver. This driver supports 8bpp
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +00001748 and 16bpp modes defined by CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806_8BPP
1749 or CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806_16BPP
1750
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001751 CONFIG_FSL_DIU_FB
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02001752 Enable the Freescale DIU video driver. Reference boards for
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001753 SOCs that have a DIU should define this macro to enable DIU
1754 support, and should also define these other macros:
1755
1756 CONFIG_SYS_DIU_ADDR
1757 CONFIG_VIDEO
1758 CONFIG_CMD_BMP
1759 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
1760 CONFIG_VIDEO_SW_CURSOR
1761 CONFIG_VGA_AS_SINGLE_DEVICE
1762 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
1763 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO
1764
Timur Tabiba8e76b2011-04-11 14:18:22 -05001765 The DIU driver will look for the 'video-mode' environment
1766 variable, and if defined, enable the DIU as a console during
1767 boot. See the documentation file README.video for a
1768 description of this variable.
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001769
Simon Glass058d59b2012-12-03 13:59:47 +00001770 CONFIG_VIDEO_VGA
1771
1772 Enable the VGA video / BIOS for x86. The alternative if you
1773 are using coreboot is to use the coreboot frame buffer
1774 driver.
1775
1776
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001777- Keyboard Support:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001778 CONFIG_KEYBOARD
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001779
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001780 Define this to enable a custom keyboard support.
1781 This simply calls drv_keyboard_init() which must be
1782 defined in your board-specific files.
1783 The only board using this so far is RBC823.
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +00001784
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001785- LCD Support: CONFIG_LCD
1786
1787 Define this to enable LCD support (for output to LCD
1788 display); also select one of the supported displays
1789 by defining one of these:
1790
Stelian Pop39cf4802008-05-09 21:57:18 +02001791 CONFIG_ATMEL_LCD:
1792
1793 HITACHI TX09D70VM1CCA, 3.5", 240x320.
1794
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001795 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448AC33:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001796
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001797 NEC NL6448AC33-18. Active, color, single scan.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001798
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001799 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC20
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001800
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001801 NEC NL6448BC20-08. 6.5", 640x480.
1802 Active, color, single scan.
1803
1804 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC33_54
1805
1806 NEC NL6448BC33-54. 10.4", 640x480.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001807 Active, color, single scan.
1808
1809 CONFIG_SHARP_16x9
1810
1811 Sharp 320x240. Active, color, single scan.
1812 It isn't 16x9, and I am not sure what it is.
1813
1814 CONFIG_SHARP_LQ64D341
1815
1816 Sharp LQ64D341 display, 640x480.
1817 Active, color, single scan.
1818
1819 CONFIG_HLD1045
1820
1821 HLD1045 display, 640x480.
1822 Active, color, single scan.
1823
1824 CONFIG_OPTREX_BW
1825
1826 Optrex CBL50840-2 NF-FW 99 22 M5
1827 or
1828 Hitachi LMG6912RPFC-00T
1829 or
1830 Hitachi SP14Q002
1831
1832 320x240. Black & white.
1833
1834 Normally display is black on white background; define
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001835 CONFIG_SYS_WHITE_ON_BLACK to get it inverted.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001836
Simon Glass676d3192012-10-17 13:24:54 +00001837 CONFIG_LCD_ALIGNMENT
1838
1839 Normally the LCD is page-aligned (tyically 4KB). If this is
1840 defined then the LCD will be aligned to this value instead.
1841 For ARM it is sometimes useful to use MMU_SECTION_SIZE
1842 here, since it is cheaper to change data cache settings on
1843 a per-section basis.
1844
Simon Glass0d89efe2012-10-17 13:24:59 +00001845 CONFIG_CONSOLE_SCROLL_LINES
1846
1847 When the console need to be scrolled, this is the number of
1848 lines to scroll by. It defaults to 1. Increasing this makes
1849 the console jump but can help speed up operation when scrolling
1850 is slow.
Simon Glass676d3192012-10-17 13:24:54 +00001851
Tom Wai-Hong Tam45d7f522012-09-28 15:11:16 +00001852 CONFIG_LCD_BMP_RLE8
1853
1854 Support drawing of RLE8-compressed bitmaps on the LCD.
1855
Tom Wai-Hong Tam735987c2012-12-05 14:46:40 +00001856 CONFIG_I2C_EDID
1857
1858 Enables an 'i2c edid' command which can read EDID
1859 information over I2C from an attached LCD display.
1860
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00001861- Splash Screen Support: CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001862
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001863 If this option is set, the environment is checked for
1864 a variable "splashimage". If found, the usual display
1865 of logo, copyright and system information on the LCD
wdenke94d2cd2004-06-30 22:59:18 +00001866 is suppressed and the BMP image at the address
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001867 specified in "splashimage" is loaded instead. The
1868 console is redirected to the "nulldev", too. This
1869 allows for a "silent" boot where a splash screen is
1870 loaded very quickly after power-on.
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001871
Nikita Kiryanovc0880482013-02-24 21:28:43 +00001872 CONFIG_SPLASHIMAGE_GUARD
1873
1874 If this option is set, then U-Boot will prevent the environment
1875 variable "splashimage" from being set to a problematic address
Tom Rini1551df32014-02-25 10:27:01 -05001876 (see README.displaying-bmps).
Nikita Kiryanovc0880482013-02-24 21:28:43 +00001877 This option is useful for targets where, due to alignment
1878 restrictions, an improperly aligned BMP image will cause a data
1879 abort. If you think you will not have problems with unaligned
1880 accesses (for example because your toolchain prevents them)
1881 there is no need to set this option.
1882
Matthias Weisser1ca298c2009-07-09 16:07:30 +02001883 CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN_ALIGN
1884
1885 If this option is set the splash image can be freely positioned
1886 on the screen. Environment variable "splashpos" specifies the
1887 position as "x,y". If a positive number is given it is used as
1888 number of pixel from left/top. If a negative number is given it
1889 is used as number of pixel from right/bottom. You can also
1890 specify 'm' for centering the image.
1891
1892 Example:
1893 setenv splashpos m,m
1894 => image at center of screen
1895
1896 setenv splashpos 30,20
1897 => image at x = 30 and y = 20
1898
1899 setenv splashpos -10,m
1900 => vertically centered image
1901 at x = dspWidth - bmpWidth - 9
1902
Stefan Roese98f4a3d2005-09-22 09:04:17 +02001903- Gzip compressed BMP image support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_GZIP
1904
1905 If this option is set, additionally to standard BMP
1906 images, gzipped BMP images can be displayed via the
1907 splashscreen support or the bmp command.
1908
Anatolij Gustschind5011762010-03-15 14:50:25 +01001909- Run length encoded BMP image (RLE8) support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_RLE8
1910
1911 If this option is set, 8-bit RLE compressed BMP images
1912 can be displayed via the splashscreen support or the
1913 bmp command.
1914
Lei Wenf2b96df2012-09-28 04:26:47 +00001915- Do compresssing for memory range:
1916 CONFIG_CMD_ZIP
1917
1918 If this option is set, it would use zlib deflate method
1919 to compress the specified memory at its best effort.
1920
wdenkc29fdfc2003-08-29 20:57:53 +00001921- Compression support:
Kees Cook8ef70472013-08-16 07:59:12 -07001922 CONFIG_GZIP
1923
1924 Enabled by default to support gzip compressed images.
1925
wdenkc29fdfc2003-08-29 20:57:53 +00001926 CONFIG_BZIP2
1927
1928 If this option is set, support for bzip2 compressed
1929 images is included. If not, only uncompressed and gzip
1930 compressed images are supported.
1931
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00001932 NOTE: the bzip2 algorithm requires a lot of RAM, so
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001933 the malloc area (as defined by CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN) should
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00001934 be at least 4MB.
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001935
Luigi 'Comio' Mantellinifc9c1722008-09-08 02:46:13 +02001936 CONFIG_LZMA
1937
1938 If this option is set, support for lzma compressed
1939 images is included.
1940
1941 Note: The LZMA algorithm adds between 2 and 4KB of code and it
1942 requires an amount of dynamic memory that is given by the
1943 formula:
1944
1945 (1846 + 768 << (lc + lp)) * sizeof(uint16)
1946
1947 Where lc and lp stand for, respectively, Literal context bits
1948 and Literal pos bits.
1949
1950 This value is upper-bounded by 14MB in the worst case. Anyway,
1951 for a ~4MB large kernel image, we have lc=3 and lp=0 for a
1952 total amount of (1846 + 768 << (3 + 0)) * 2 = ~41KB... that is
1953 a very small buffer.
1954
1955 Use the lzmainfo tool to determinate the lc and lp values and
1956 then calculate the amount of needed dynamic memory (ensuring
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001957 the appropriate CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN value).
Luigi 'Comio' Mantellinifc9c1722008-09-08 02:46:13 +02001958
Kees Cook8ef70472013-08-16 07:59:12 -07001959 CONFIG_LZO
1960
1961 If this option is set, support for LZO compressed images
1962 is included.
1963
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001964- MII/PHY support:
1965 CONFIG_PHY_ADDR
1966
1967 The address of PHY on MII bus.
1968
1969 CONFIG_PHY_CLOCK_FREQ (ppc4xx)
1970
1971 The clock frequency of the MII bus
1972
1973 CONFIG_PHY_GIGE
1974
1975 If this option is set, support for speed/duplex
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001976 detection of gigabit PHY is included.
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001977
1978 CONFIG_PHY_RESET_DELAY
1979
1980 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
1981 reset before any MII register access is possible.
1982 For such PHY, set this option to the usec delay
1983 required. (minimum 300usec for LXT971A)
1984
1985 CONFIG_PHY_CMD_DELAY (ppc4xx)
1986
1987 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
1988 command issued before MII status register can be read
1989
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001990- Ethernet address:
1991 CONFIG_ETHADDR
richardretanubunc68a05f2008-09-29 18:28:23 -04001992 CONFIG_ETH1ADDR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001993 CONFIG_ETH2ADDR
1994 CONFIG_ETH3ADDR
richardretanubunc68a05f2008-09-29 18:28:23 -04001995 CONFIG_ETH4ADDR
1996 CONFIG_ETH5ADDR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001997
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001998 Define a default value for Ethernet address to use
1999 for the respective Ethernet interface, in case this
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002000 is not determined automatically.
2001
2002- IP address:
2003 CONFIG_IPADDR
2004
2005 Define a default value for the IP address to use for
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002006 the default Ethernet interface, in case this is not
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002007 determined through e.g. bootp.
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00002008 (Environment variable "ipaddr")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002009
2010- Server IP address:
2011 CONFIG_SERVERIP
2012
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002013 Defines a default value for the IP address of a TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002014 server to contact when using the "tftboot" command.
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00002015 (Environment variable "serverip")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002016
Robin Getz97cfe862009-07-21 12:15:28 -04002017 CONFIG_KEEP_SERVERADDR
2018
2019 Keeps the server's MAC address, in the env 'serveraddr'
2020 for passing to bootargs (like Linux's netconsole option)
2021
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00002022- Gateway IP address:
2023 CONFIG_GATEWAYIP
2024
2025 Defines a default value for the IP address of the
2026 default router where packets to other networks are
2027 sent to.
2028 (Environment variable "gatewayip")
2029
2030- Subnet mask:
2031 CONFIG_NETMASK
2032
2033 Defines a default value for the subnet mask (or
2034 routing prefix) which is used to determine if an IP
2035 address belongs to the local subnet or needs to be
2036 forwarded through a router.
2037 (Environment variable "netmask")
2038
David Updegraff53a5c422007-06-11 10:41:07 -05002039- Multicast TFTP Mode:
2040 CONFIG_MCAST_TFTP
2041
2042 Defines whether you want to support multicast TFTP as per
2043 rfc-2090; for example to work with atftp. Lets lots of targets
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002044 tftp down the same boot image concurrently. Note: the Ethernet
David Updegraff53a5c422007-06-11 10:41:07 -05002045 driver in use must provide a function: mcast() to join/leave a
2046 multicast group.
2047
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002048- BOOTP Recovery Mode:
2049 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY
2050
2051 If you have many targets in a network that try to
2052 boot using BOOTP, you may want to avoid that all
2053 systems send out BOOTP requests at precisely the same
2054 moment (which would happen for instance at recovery
2055 from a power failure, when all systems will try to
2056 boot, thus flooding the BOOTP server. Defining
2057 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY causes a random delay to be
2058 inserted before sending out BOOTP requests. The
Wolfgang Denk6c33c782007-08-06 23:21:05 +02002059 following delays are inserted then:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002060
2061 1st BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 1 sec
2062 2nd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 2 sec
2063 3rd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 4 sec
2064 4th and following
2065 BOOTP requests: delay 0 ... 8 sec
2066
Thierry Reding92ac8ac2014-08-19 10:21:24 +02002067 CONFIG_BOOTP_ID_CACHE_SIZE
2068
2069 BOOTP packets are uniquely identified using a 32-bit ID. The
2070 server will copy the ID from client requests to responses and
2071 U-Boot will use this to determine if it is the destination of
2072 an incoming response. Some servers will check that addresses
2073 aren't in use before handing them out (usually using an ARP
2074 ping) and therefore take up to a few hundred milliseconds to
2075 respond. Network congestion may also influence the time it
2076 takes for a response to make it back to the client. If that
2077 time is too long, U-Boot will retransmit requests. In order
2078 to allow earlier responses to still be accepted after these
2079 retransmissions, U-Boot's BOOTP client keeps a small cache of
2080 IDs. The CONFIG_BOOTP_ID_CACHE_SIZE controls the size of this
2081 cache. The default is to keep IDs for up to four outstanding
2082 requests. Increasing this will allow U-Boot to accept offers
2083 from a BOOTP client in networks with unusually high latency.
2084
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002085- DHCP Advanced Options:
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05002086 You can fine tune the DHCP functionality by defining
2087 CONFIG_BOOTP_* symbols:
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002088
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05002089 CONFIG_BOOTP_SUBNETMASK
2090 CONFIG_BOOTP_GATEWAY
2091 CONFIG_BOOTP_HOSTNAME
2092 CONFIG_BOOTP_NISDOMAIN
2093 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTPATH
2094 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTFILESIZE
2095 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
2096 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2
2097 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME
2098 CONFIG_BOOTP_NTPSERVER
2099 CONFIG_BOOTP_TIMEOFFSET
2100 CONFIG_BOOTP_VENDOREX
Joe Hershberger2c00e092012-05-23 07:59:19 +00002101 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002102
Wilson Callan5d110f02007-07-28 10:56:13 -04002103 CONFIG_BOOTP_SERVERIP - TFTP server will be the serverip
2104 environment variable, not the BOOTP server.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002105
Joe Hershberger2c00e092012-05-23 07:59:19 +00002106 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL - If the DHCP server is not found
2107 after the configured retry count, the call will fail
2108 instead of starting over. This can be used to fail over
2109 to Link-local IP address configuration if the DHCP server
2110 is not available.
2111
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002112 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 - If a DHCP client requests the DNS
2113 serverip from a DHCP server, it is possible that more
2114 than one DNS serverip is offered to the client.
2115 If CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 is enabled, the secondary DNS
2116 serverip will be stored in the additional environment
2117 variable "dnsip2". The first DNS serverip is always
2118 stored in the variable "dnsip", when CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05002119 is defined.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002120
2121 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME - Some DHCP servers are capable
2122 to do a dynamic update of a DNS server. To do this, they
2123 need the hostname of the DHCP requester.
Wilson Callan5d110f02007-07-28 10:56:13 -04002124 If CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME is defined, the content
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05002125 of the "hostname" environment variable is passed as
2126 option 12 to the DHCP server.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002127
Aras Vaichasd9a2f412008-03-26 09:43:57 +11002128 CONFIG_BOOTP_DHCP_REQUEST_DELAY
2129
2130 A 32bit value in microseconds for a delay between
2131 receiving a "DHCP Offer" and sending the "DHCP Request".
2132 This fixes a problem with certain DHCP servers that don't
2133 respond 100% of the time to a "DHCP request". E.g. On an
2134 AT91RM9200 processor running at 180MHz, this delay needed
2135 to be *at least* 15,000 usec before a Windows Server 2003
2136 DHCP server would reply 100% of the time. I recommend at
2137 least 50,000 usec to be safe. The alternative is to hope
2138 that one of the retries will be successful but note that
2139 the DHCP timeout and retry process takes a longer than
2140 this delay.
2141
Joe Hershbergerd22c3382012-05-23 08:00:12 +00002142 - Link-local IP address negotiation:
2143 Negotiate with other link-local clients on the local network
2144 for an address that doesn't require explicit configuration.
2145 This is especially useful if a DHCP server cannot be guaranteed
2146 to exist in all environments that the device must operate.
2147
2148 See doc/README.link-local for more information.
2149
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00002150 - CDP Options:
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00002151 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00002152
2153 The device id used in CDP trigger frames.
2154
2155 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID_PREFIX
2156
2157 A two character string which is prefixed to the MAC address
2158 of the device.
2159
2160 CONFIG_CDP_PORT_ID
2161
2162 A printf format string which contains the ascii name of
2163 the port. Normally is set to "eth%d" which sets
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002164 eth0 for the first Ethernet, eth1 for the second etc.
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00002165
2166 CONFIG_CDP_CAPABILITIES
2167
2168 A 32bit integer which indicates the device capabilities;
2169 0x00000010 for a normal host which does not forwards.
2170
2171 CONFIG_CDP_VERSION
2172
2173 An ascii string containing the version of the software.
2174
2175 CONFIG_CDP_PLATFORM
2176
2177 An ascii string containing the name of the platform.
2178
2179 CONFIG_CDP_TRIGGER
2180
2181 A 32bit integer sent on the trigger.
2182
2183 CONFIG_CDP_POWER_CONSUMPTION
2184
2185 A 16bit integer containing the power consumption of the
2186 device in .1 of milliwatts.
2187
2188 CONFIG_CDP_APPLIANCE_VLAN_TYPE
2189
2190 A byte containing the id of the VLAN.
2191
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002192- Status LED: CONFIG_STATUS_LED
2193
2194 Several configurations allow to display the current
2195 status using a LED. For instance, the LED will blink
2196 fast while running U-Boot code, stop blinking as
2197 soon as a reply to a BOOTP request was received, and
2198 start blinking slow once the Linux kernel is running
2199 (supported by a status LED driver in the Linux
2200 kernel). Defining CONFIG_STATUS_LED enables this
2201 feature in U-Boot.
2202
Igor Grinberg1df7bbb2013-11-08 01:03:50 +02002203 Additional options:
2204
2205 CONFIG_GPIO_LED
2206 The status LED can be connected to a GPIO pin.
2207 In such cases, the gpio_led driver can be used as a
2208 status LED backend implementation. Define CONFIG_GPIO_LED
2209 to include the gpio_led driver in the U-Boot binary.
2210
Igor Grinberg9dfdcdf2013-11-08 01:03:52 +02002211 CONFIG_GPIO_LED_INVERTED_TABLE
2212 Some GPIO connected LEDs may have inverted polarity in which
2213 case the GPIO high value corresponds to LED off state and
2214 GPIO low value corresponds to LED on state.
2215 In such cases CONFIG_GPIO_LED_INVERTED_TABLE may be defined
2216 with a list of GPIO LEDs that have inverted polarity.
2217
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002218- CAN Support: CONFIG_CAN_DRIVER
2219
2220 Defining CONFIG_CAN_DRIVER enables CAN driver support
2221 on those systems that support this (optional)
2222 feature, like the TQM8xxL modules.
2223
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002224- I2C Support: CONFIG_SYS_I2C
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002225
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002226 This enable the NEW i2c subsystem, and will allow you to use
2227 i2c commands at the u-boot command line (as long as you set
2228 CONFIG_CMD_I2C in CONFIG_COMMANDS) and communicate with i2c
2229 based realtime clock chips or other i2c devices. See
2230 common/cmd_i2c.c for a description of the command line
2231 interface.
2232
2233 ported i2c driver to the new framework:
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002234 - drivers/i2c/soft_i2c.c:
2235 - activate first bus with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT define
2236 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE
2237 for defining speed and slave address
2238 - activate second bus with I2C_SOFT_DECLARATIONS2 define
2239 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED_2 and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE_2
2240 for defining speed and slave address
2241 - activate third bus with I2C_SOFT_DECLARATIONS3 define
2242 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED_3 and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE_3
2243 for defining speed and slave address
2244 - activate fourth bus with I2C_SOFT_DECLARATIONS4 define
2245 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED_4 and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE_4
2246 for defining speed and slave address
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002247
Heiko Schocher00f792e2012-10-24 13:48:22 +02002248 - drivers/i2c/fsl_i2c.c:
2249 - activate i2c driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_FSL
2250 define CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C_OFFSET for setting the register
2251 offset CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C_SPEED for the i2c speed and
2252 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C_SLAVE for the slave addr of the first
2253 bus.
Wolfgang Denk93e14592013-10-04 17:43:24 +02002254 - If your board supports a second fsl i2c bus, define
Heiko Schocher00f792e2012-10-24 13:48:22 +02002255 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C2_OFFSET for the register offset
2256 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C2_SPEED for the speed and
2257 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C2_SLAVE for the slave address of the
2258 second bus.
2259
Simon Glass1f2ba722012-10-30 07:28:53 +00002260 - drivers/i2c/tegra_i2c.c:
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu10cee512013-10-11 16:23:53 +09002261 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_TEGRA
2262 - This driver adds 4 i2c buses with a fix speed from
2263 100000 and the slave addr 0!
Simon Glass1f2ba722012-10-30 07:28:53 +00002264
Dirk Eibach880540d2013-04-25 02:40:01 +00002265 - drivers/i2c/ppc4xx_i2c.c
2266 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PPC4XX
2267 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PPC4XX_CH0 activate hardware channel 0
2268 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PPC4XX_CH1 activate hardware channel 1
2269
tremfac96402013-09-21 18:13:35 +02002270 - drivers/i2c/i2c_mxc.c
2271 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC
2272 - define speed for bus 1 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C1_SPEED
2273 - define slave for bus 1 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C1_SLAVE
2274 - define speed for bus 2 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C2_SPEED
2275 - define slave for bus 2 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C2_SLAVE
2276 - define speed for bus 3 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C3_SPEED
2277 - define slave for bus 3 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C3_SLAVE
2278 If thoses defines are not set, default value is 100000
2279 for speed, and 0 for slave.
2280
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu1086bfa2013-09-27 16:58:30 +09002281 - drivers/i2c/rcar_i2c.c:
2282 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_RCAR
2283 - This driver adds 4 i2c buses
2284
2285 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C0_BASE for setting the register channel 0
2286 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C0_SPEED for for the speed channel 0
2287 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C1_BASE for setting the register channel 1
2288 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C1_SPEED for for the speed channel 1
2289 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C2_BASE for setting the register channel 2
2290 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C2_SPEED for for the speed channel 2
2291 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C3_BASE for setting the register channel 3
2292 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C3_SPEED for for the speed channel 3
2293 - CONFIF_SYS_RCAR_I2C_NUM_CONTROLLERS for number of i2c buses
2294
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu2035d772013-10-29 13:33:51 +09002295 - drivers/i2c/sh_i2c.c:
2296 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH
2297 - This driver adds from 2 to 5 i2c buses
2298
2299 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE0 for setting the register channel 0
2300 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED0 for for the speed channel 0
2301 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE1 for setting the register channel 1
2302 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED1 for for the speed channel 1
2303 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE2 for setting the register channel 2
2304 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED2 for for the speed channel 2
2305 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE3 for setting the register channel 3
2306 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED3 for for the speed channel 3
2307 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE4 for setting the register channel 4
2308 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED4 for for the speed channel 4
2309 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE5 for setting the register channel 5
2310 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED5 for for the speed channel 5
2311 - CONFIF_SYS_I2C_SH_NUM_CONTROLLERS for nummber of i2c buses
2312
Heiko Schocher6789e842013-10-22 11:03:18 +02002313 - drivers/i2c/omap24xx_i2c.c
2314 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_OMAP24XX
2315 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED speed channel 0
2316 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE slave addr channel 0
2317 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED1 speed channel 1
2318 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE1 slave addr channel 1
2319 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED2 speed channel 2
2320 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE2 slave addr channel 2
2321 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED3 speed channel 3
2322 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE3 slave addr channel 3
2323 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED4 speed channel 4
2324 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE4 slave addr channel 4
2325
Heiko Schocher0bdffe72013-11-08 07:30:53 +01002326 - drivers/i2c/zynq_i2c.c
2327 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_ZYNQ
2328 - set CONFIG_SYS_I2C_ZYNQ_SPEED for speed setting
2329 - set CONFIG_SYS_I2C_ZYNQ_SLAVE for slave addr
2330
Naveen Krishna Che717fc62013-12-06 12:12:38 +05302331 - drivers/i2c/s3c24x0_i2c.c:
2332 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_S3C24X0
2333 - This driver adds i2c buses (11 for Exynos5250, Exynos5420
2334 9 i2c buses for Exynos4 and 1 for S3C24X0 SoCs from Samsung)
2335 with a fix speed from 100000 and the slave addr 0!
2336
Dirk Eibachb46226b2014-07-03 09:28:18 +02002337 - drivers/i2c/ihs_i2c.c
2338 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS
2339 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH0 activate hardware channel 0
2340 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_0 speed channel 0
2341 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_0 slave addr channel 0
2342 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH1 activate hardware channel 1
2343 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_1 speed channel 1
2344 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_1 slave addr channel 1
2345 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH2 activate hardware channel 2
2346 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_2 speed channel 2
2347 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_2 slave addr channel 2
2348 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH3 activate hardware channel 3
2349 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_3 speed channel 3
2350 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_3 slave addr channel 3
2351
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002352 additional defines:
2353
2354 CONFIG_SYS_NUM_I2C_BUSES
2355 Hold the number of i2c busses you want to use. If you
2356 don't use/have i2c muxes on your i2c bus, this
2357 is equal to CONFIG_SYS_NUM_I2C_ADAPTERS, and you can
2358 omit this define.
2359
2360 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DIRECT_BUS
2361 define this, if you don't use i2c muxes on your hardware.
2362 if CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MAX_HOPS is not defined or == 0 you can
2363 omit this define.
2364
2365 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MAX_HOPS
2366 define how many muxes are maximal consecutively connected
2367 on one i2c bus. If you not use i2c muxes, omit this
2368 define.
2369
2370 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BUSES
2371 hold a list of busses you want to use, only used if
2372 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DIRECT_BUS is not defined, for example
2373 a board with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MAX_HOPS = 1 and
2374 CONFIG_SYS_NUM_I2C_BUSES = 9:
2375
2376 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BUSES {{0, {I2C_NULL_HOP}}, \
2377 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 1}}}, \
2378 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 2}}}, \
2379 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 3}}}, \
2380 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 4}}}, \
2381 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 5}}}, \
2382 {1, {I2C_NULL_HOP}}, \
2383 {1, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9544, 0x72, 1}}}, \
2384 {1, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9544, 0x72, 2}}}, \
2385 }
2386
2387 which defines
2388 bus 0 on adapter 0 without a mux
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002389 bus 1 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 1
2390 bus 2 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 2
2391 bus 3 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 3
2392 bus 4 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 4
2393 bus 5 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 5
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002394 bus 6 on adapter 1 without a mux
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002395 bus 7 on adapter 1 with a PCA9544 on address 0x72 port 1
2396 bus 8 on adapter 1 with a PCA9544 on address 0x72 port 2
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002397
2398 If you do not have i2c muxes on your board, omit this define.
2399
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002400- Legacy I2C Support: CONFIG_HARD_I2C
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002401
2402 NOTE: It is intended to move drivers to CONFIG_SYS_I2C which
2403 provides the following compelling advantages:
2404
2405 - more than one i2c adapter is usable
2406 - approved multibus support
2407 - better i2c mux support
2408
2409 ** Please consider updating your I2C driver now. **
2410
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002411 These enable legacy I2C serial bus commands. Defining
2412 CONFIG_HARD_I2C will include the appropriate I2C driver
2413 for the selected CPU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002414
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002415 This will allow you to use i2c commands at the u-boot
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05002416 command line (as long as you set CONFIG_CMD_I2C in
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002417 CONFIG_COMMANDS) and communicate with i2c based realtime
2418 clock chips. See common/cmd_i2c.c for a description of the
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002419 command line interface.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002420
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002421 CONFIG_HARD_I2C selects a hardware I2C controller.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002422
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002423 There are several other quantities that must also be
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002424 defined when you define CONFIG_HARD_I2C.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002425
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002426 In both cases you will need to define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SPEED
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002427 to be the frequency (in Hz) at which you wish your i2c bus
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002428 to run and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SLAVE to be the address of this node (ie
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002429 the CPU's i2c node address).
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002430
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -05002431 Now, the u-boot i2c code for the mpc8xx
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02002432 (arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc8xx/i2c.c) sets the CPU up as a master node
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -05002433 and so its address should therefore be cleared to 0 (See,
2434 eg, MPC823e User's Manual p.16-473). So, set
2435 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SLAVE to 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002436
Eric Millbrandt5da71ef2009-09-03 08:09:44 -05002437 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_MPC5XXX
2438
2439 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
2440 chips might think that the current transfer is still
2441 in progress. Reset the slave devices by sending start
2442 commands until the slave device responds.
2443
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002444 That's all that's required for CONFIG_HARD_I2C.
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002445
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002446 If you use the software i2c interface (CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT)
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002447 then the following macros need to be defined (examples are
2448 from include/configs/lwmon.h):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002449
2450 I2C_INIT
2451
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002452 (Optional). Any commands necessary to enable the I2C
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002453 controller or configure ports.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002454
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002455 eg: #define I2C_INIT (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SCL)
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002456
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002457 I2C_PORT
2458
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002459 (Only for MPC8260 CPU). The I/O port to use (the code
2460 assumes both bits are on the same port). Valid values
2461 are 0..3 for ports A..D.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002462
2463 I2C_ACTIVE
2464
2465 The code necessary to make the I2C data line active
2466 (driven). If the data line is open collector, this
2467 define can be null.
2468
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002469 eg: #define I2C_ACTIVE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SDA)
2470
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002471 I2C_TRISTATE
2472
2473 The code necessary to make the I2C data line tri-stated
2474 (inactive). If the data line is open collector, this
2475 define can be null.
2476
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002477 eg: #define I2C_TRISTATE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir &= ~PB_SDA)
2478
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002479 I2C_READ
2480
York Sun472d5462013-04-01 11:29:11 -07002481 Code that returns true if the I2C data line is high,
2482 false if it is low.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002483
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002484 eg: #define I2C_READ ((immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat & PB_SDA) != 0)
2485
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002486 I2C_SDA(bit)
2487
York Sun472d5462013-04-01 11:29:11 -07002488 If <bit> is true, sets the I2C data line high. If it
2489 is false, it clears it (low).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002490
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002491 eg: #define I2C_SDA(bit) \
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00002492 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SDA; \
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002493 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SDA
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002494
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002495 I2C_SCL(bit)
2496
York Sun472d5462013-04-01 11:29:11 -07002497 If <bit> is true, sets the I2C clock line high. If it
2498 is false, it clears it (low).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002499
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002500 eg: #define I2C_SCL(bit) \
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00002501 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SCL; \
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002502 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SCL
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002503
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002504 I2C_DELAY
2505
2506 This delay is invoked four times per clock cycle so this
2507 controls the rate of data transfer. The data rate thus
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002508 is 1 / (I2C_DELAY * 4). Often defined to be something
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002509 like:
2510
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002511 #define I2C_DELAY udelay(2)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002512
Mike Frysinger793b5722010-07-21 13:38:02 -04002513 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SCL / CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SDA
2514
2515 If your arch supports the generic GPIO framework (asm/gpio.h),
2516 then you may alternatively define the two GPIOs that are to be
2517 used as SCL / SDA. Any of the previous I2C_xxx macros will
2518 have GPIO-based defaults assigned to them as appropriate.
2519
2520 You should define these to the GPIO value as given directly to
2521 the generic GPIO functions.
2522
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002523 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002524
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002525 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
2526 chips might think that the current transfer is still
2527 in progress. On some boards it is possible to access
2528 the i2c SCLK line directly, either by using the
2529 processor pin as a GPIO or by having a second pin
2530 connected to the bus. If this option is defined a
2531 custom i2c_init_board() routine in boards/xxx/board.c
2532 is run early in the boot sequence.
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002533
Richard Retanubun26a33502010-04-12 15:08:17 -04002534 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BOARD_LATE_INIT
2535
2536 An alternative to CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD. If this option is
2537 defined a custom i2c_board_late_init() routine in
2538 boards/xxx/board.c is run AFTER the operations in i2c_init()
2539 is completed. This callpoint can be used to unreset i2c bus
2540 using CPU i2c controller register accesses for CPUs whose i2c
2541 controller provide such a method. It is called at the end of
2542 i2c_init() to allow i2c_init operations to setup the i2c bus
2543 controller on the CPU (e.g. setting bus speed & slave address).
2544
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00002545 CONFIG_I2CFAST (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
2546
2547 This option enables configuration of bi_iic_fast[] flags
2548 in u-boot bd_info structure based on u-boot environment
2549 variable "i2cfast". (see also i2cfast)
2550
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002551 CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
2552
2553 This option allows the use of multiple I2C buses, each of which
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002554 must have a controller. At any point in time, only one bus is
2555 active. To switch to a different bus, use the 'i2c dev' command.
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002556 Note that bus numbering is zero-based.
2557
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002558 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002559
2560 This option specifies a list of I2C devices that will be skipped
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002561 when the 'i2c probe' command is issued. If CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Peter Tyser0f89c542009-04-18 22:34:03 -05002562 is set, specify a list of bus-device pairs. Otherwise, specify
2563 a 1D array of device addresses
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002564
2565 e.g.
2566 #undef CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002567 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES {0x50,0x68}
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002568
2569 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on a board with one I2C bus
2570
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002571 #define CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002572 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MULTI_NOPROBES {{0,0x50},{0,0x68},{1,0x54}}
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002573
2574 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on bus 0 and address 0x54 on bus 1
2575
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002576 CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Timur Tabibe5e61812006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002577
2578 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for DDR SPD.
2579 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that SPD is on I2C bus 0.
2580
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002581 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese0dc018e2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01002582
2583 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the RTC.
2584 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that RTC is on I2C bus 0.
2585
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002586 CONFIG_SYS_DTT_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese0dc018e2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01002587
2588 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the DTT.
2589 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that DTT is on I2C bus 0.
2590
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002591 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DTT_ADDR:
Victor Gallardo9ebbb542008-09-09 15:13:29 -07002592
2593 If defined, specifies the I2C address of the DTT device.
2594 If not defined, then U-Boot uses predefined value for
2595 specified DTT device.
2596
Andrew Dyer2ac69852008-12-29 17:36:01 -06002597 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_READ_REPEATED_START
2598
2599 defining this will force the i2c_read() function in
2600 the soft_i2c driver to perform an I2C repeated start
2601 between writing the address pointer and reading the
2602 data. If this define is omitted the default behaviour
2603 of doing a stop-start sequence will be used. Most I2C
2604 devices can use either method, but some require one or
2605 the other.
Timur Tabibe5e61812006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002606
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002607- SPI Support: CONFIG_SPI
2608
2609 Enables SPI driver (so far only tested with
2610 SPI EEPROM, also an instance works with Crystal A/D and
2611 D/As on the SACSng board)
2612
Yoshihiro Shimoda66395622011-01-31 16:50:43 +09002613 CONFIG_SH_SPI
2614
2615 Enables the driver for SPI controller on SuperH. Currently
2616 only SH7757 is supported.
2617
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002618 CONFIG_SPI_X
2619
2620 Enables extended (16-bit) SPI EEPROM addressing.
2621 (symmetrical to CONFIG_I2C_X)
2622
2623 CONFIG_SOFT_SPI
2624
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002625 Enables a software (bit-bang) SPI driver rather than
2626 using hardware support. This is a general purpose
2627 driver that only requires three general I/O port pins
2628 (two outputs, one input) to function. If this is
2629 defined, the board configuration must define several
2630 SPI configuration items (port pins to use, etc). For
2631 an example, see include/configs/sacsng.h.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002632
Ben Warren04a9e112008-01-16 22:37:35 -05002633 CONFIG_HARD_SPI
2634
2635 Enables a hardware SPI driver for general-purpose reads
2636 and writes. As with CONFIG_SOFT_SPI, the board configuration
2637 must define a list of chip-select function pointers.
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002638 Currently supported on some MPC8xxx processors. For an
Ben Warren04a9e112008-01-16 22:37:35 -05002639 example, see include/configs/mpc8349emds.h.
2640
Guennadi Liakhovetski38254f42008-04-15 14:14:25 +02002641 CONFIG_MXC_SPI
2642
2643 Enables the driver for the SPI controllers on i.MX and MXC
Fabio Estevam2e3cd1c2011-10-28 08:57:46 +00002644 SoCs. Currently i.MX31/35/51 are supported.
Guennadi Liakhovetski38254f42008-04-15 14:14:25 +02002645
Heiko Schocherf659b572014-07-14 10:22:11 +02002646 CONFIG_SYS_SPI_MXC_WAIT
2647 Timeout for waiting until spi transfer completed.
2648 default: (CONFIG_SYS_HZ/100) /* 10 ms */
2649
Matthias Fuchs01335022007-12-27 17:12:34 +01002650- FPGA Support: CONFIG_FPGA
2651
2652 Enables FPGA subsystem.
2653
2654 CONFIG_FPGA_<vendor>
2655
2656 Enables support for specific chip vendors.
2657 (ALTERA, XILINX)
2658
2659 CONFIG_FPGA_<family>
2660
2661 Enables support for FPGA family.
2662 (SPARTAN2, SPARTAN3, VIRTEX2, CYCLONE2, ACEX1K, ACEX)
2663
2664 CONFIG_FPGA_COUNT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002665
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002666 Specify the number of FPGA devices to support.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002667
Siva Durga Prasad Paladugu64e809a2014-03-14 16:35:38 +05302668 CONFIG_CMD_FPGA_LOADMK
2669
2670 Enable support for fpga loadmk command
2671
Michal Simek67193862014-05-02 13:43:39 +02002672 CONFIG_CMD_FPGA_LOADP
2673
2674 Enable support for fpga loadp command - load partial bitstream
2675
2676 CONFIG_CMD_FPGA_LOADBP
2677
2678 Enable support for fpga loadbp command - load partial bitstream
2679 (Xilinx only)
2680
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002681 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_PROG_FEEDBACK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002682
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002683 Enable printing of hash marks during FPGA configuration.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002684
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002685 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002686
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002687 Enable checks on FPGA configuration interface busy
2688 status by the configuration function. This option
2689 will require a board or device specific function to
2690 be written.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002691
2692 CONFIG_FPGA_DELAY
2693
2694 If defined, a function that provides delays in the FPGA
2695 configuration driver.
2696
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002697 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_CTRLC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002698 Allow Control-C to interrupt FPGA configuration
2699
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002700 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_ERROR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002701
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002702 Check for configuration errors during FPGA bitfile
2703 loading. For example, abort during Virtex II
2704 configuration if the INIT_B line goes low (which
2705 indicated a CRC error).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002706
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002707 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_INIT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002708
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002709 Maximum time to wait for the INIT_B line to deassert
2710 after PROB_B has been deasserted during a Virtex II
2711 FPGA configuration sequence. The default time is 500
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002712 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002713
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002714 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002715
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002716 Maximum time to wait for BUSY to deassert during
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002717 Virtex II FPGA configuration. The default is 5 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002718
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002719 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_CONFIG
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002720
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002721 Time to wait after FPGA configuration. The default is
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002722 200 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002723
2724- Configuration Management:
2725 CONFIG_IDENT_STRING
2726
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002727 If defined, this string will be added to the U-Boot
2728 version information (U_BOOT_VERSION)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002729
2730- Vendor Parameter Protection:
2731
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002732 U-Boot considers the values of the environment
2733 variables "serial#" (Board Serial Number) and
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002734 "ethaddr" (Ethernet Address) to be parameters that
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002735 are set once by the board vendor / manufacturer, and
2736 protects these variables from casual modification by
2737 the user. Once set, these variables are read-only,
2738 and write or delete attempts are rejected. You can
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002739 change this behaviour:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002740
2741 If CONFIG_ENV_OVERWRITE is #defined in your config
2742 file, the write protection for vendor parameters is
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002743 completely disabled. Anybody can change or delete
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002744 these parameters.
2745
2746 Alternatively, if you #define _both_ CONFIG_ETHADDR
2747 _and_ CONFIG_OVERWRITE_ETHADDR_ONCE, a default
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002748 Ethernet address is installed in the environment,
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002749 which can be changed exactly ONCE by the user. [The
2750 serial# is unaffected by this, i. e. it remains
2751 read-only.]
2752
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06002753 The same can be accomplished in a more flexible way
2754 for any variable by configuring the type of access
2755 to allow for those variables in the ".flags" variable
2756 or define CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC.
2757
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002758- Protected RAM:
2759 CONFIG_PRAM
2760
2761 Define this variable to enable the reservation of
2762 "protected RAM", i. e. RAM which is not overwritten
2763 by U-Boot. Define CONFIG_PRAM to hold the number of
2764 kB you want to reserve for pRAM. You can overwrite
2765 this default value by defining an environment
2766 variable "pram" to the number of kB you want to
2767 reserve. Note that the board info structure will
2768 still show the full amount of RAM. If pRAM is
2769 reserved, a new environment variable "mem" will
2770 automatically be defined to hold the amount of
2771 remaining RAM in a form that can be passed as boot
2772 argument to Linux, for instance like that:
2773
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01002774 setenv bootargs ... mem=\${mem}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002775 saveenv
2776
2777 This way you can tell Linux not to use this memory,
2778 either, which results in a memory region that will
2779 not be affected by reboots.
2780
2781 *WARNING* If your board configuration uses automatic
2782 detection of the RAM size, you must make sure that
2783 this memory test is non-destructive. So far, the
2784 following board configurations are known to be
2785 "pRAM-clean":
2786
Wolfgang Denk1b0757e2012-10-24 02:36:15 +00002787 IVMS8, IVML24, SPD8xx, TQM8xxL,
2788 HERMES, IP860, RPXlite, LWMON,
Wolfgang Denk544d97e2010-10-05 22:54:53 +02002789 FLAGADM, TQM8260
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002790
Gabe Black40fef042012-12-02 04:55:18 +00002791- Access to physical memory region (> 4GB)
2792 Some basic support is provided for operations on memory not
2793 normally accessible to U-Boot - e.g. some architectures
2794 support access to more than 4GB of memory on 32-bit
2795 machines using physical address extension or similar.
2796 Define CONFIG_PHYSMEM to access this basic support, which
2797 currently only supports clearing the memory.
2798
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002799- Error Recovery:
2800 CONFIG_PANIC_HANG
2801
2802 Define this variable to stop the system in case of a
2803 fatal error, so that you have to reset it manually.
2804 This is probably NOT a good idea for an embedded
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002805 system where you want the system to reboot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002806 automatically as fast as possible, but it may be
2807 useful during development since you can try to debug
2808 the conditions that lead to the situation.
2809
2810 CONFIG_NET_RETRY_COUNT
2811
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002812 This variable defines the number of retries for
2813 network operations like ARP, RARP, TFTP, or BOOTP
2814 before giving up the operation. If not defined, a
2815 default value of 5 is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002816
Guennadi Liakhovetski40cb90e2008-04-03 17:04:19 +02002817 CONFIG_ARP_TIMEOUT
2818
2819 Timeout waiting for an ARP reply in milliseconds.
2820
Tetsuyuki Kobayashi48a3e992012-07-03 22:25:21 +00002821 CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT
2822
2823 Timeout in milliseconds used in NFS protocol.
2824 If you encounter "ERROR: Cannot umount" in nfs command,
2825 try longer timeout such as
2826 #define CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT 10000UL
2827
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002828- Command Interpreter:
Wolfgang Denk8078f1a2006-10-28 02:28:02 +02002829 CONFIG_AUTO_COMPLETE
wdenk04a85b32004-04-15 18:22:41 +00002830
2831 Enable auto completion of commands using TAB.
2832
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01002833 Note that this feature has NOT been implemented yet
2834 for the "hush" shell.
Wolfgang Denk8078f1a2006-10-28 02:28:02 +02002835
2836
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002837 CONFIG_SYS_HUSH_PARSER
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002838
2839 Define this variable to enable the "hush" shell (from
2840 Busybox) as command line interpreter, thus enabling
2841 powerful command line syntax like
2842 if...then...else...fi conditionals or `&&' and '||'
2843 constructs ("shell scripts").
2844
2845 If undefined, you get the old, much simpler behaviour
2846 with a somewhat smaller memory footprint.
2847
2848
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002849 CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT_HUSH_PS2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002850
2851 This defines the secondary prompt string, which is
2852 printed when the command interpreter needs more input
2853 to complete a command. Usually "> ".
2854
2855 Note:
2856
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002857 In the current implementation, the local variables
2858 space and global environment variables space are
2859 separated. Local variables are those you define by
2860 simply typing `name=value'. To access a local
2861 variable later on, you have write `$name' or
2862 `${name}'; to execute the contents of a variable
2863 directly type `$name' at the command prompt.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002864
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002865 Global environment variables are those you use
2866 setenv/printenv to work with. To run a command stored
2867 in such a variable, you need to use the run command,
2868 and you must not use the '$' sign to access them.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002869
2870 To store commands and special characters in a
2871 variable, please use double quotation marks
2872 surrounding the whole text of the variable, instead
2873 of the backslashes before semicolons and special
2874 symbols.
2875
Wolfgang Denkaa0c71a2006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002876- Commandline Editing and History:
2877 CONFIG_CMDLINE_EDITING
2878
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002879 Enable editing and History functions for interactive
Wolfgang Denkb9365a22006-07-21 11:56:05 +02002880 commandline input operations
Wolfgang Denkaa0c71a2006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002881
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002882- Default Environment:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002883 CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS
2884
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002885 Define this to contain any number of null terminated
2886 strings (variable = value pairs) that will be part of
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002887 the default environment compiled into the boot image.
wdenk2262cfe2002-11-18 00:14:45 +00002888
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002889 For example, place something like this in your
2890 board's config file:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002891
2892 #define CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS \
2893 "myvar1=value1\0" \
2894 "myvar2=value2\0"
2895
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002896 Warning: This method is based on knowledge about the
2897 internal format how the environment is stored by the
2898 U-Boot code. This is NOT an official, exported
2899 interface! Although it is unlikely that this format
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002900 will change soon, there is no guarantee either.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002901 You better know what you are doing here.
2902
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002903 Note: overly (ab)use of the default environment is
2904 discouraged. Make sure to check other ways to preset
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02002905 the environment like the "source" command or the
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002906 boot command first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002907
Stephen Warren5e724ca2012-05-22 09:21:54 +00002908 CONFIG_ENV_VARS_UBOOT_CONFIG
2909
2910 Define this in order to add variables describing the
2911 U-Boot build configuration to the default environment.
2912 These will be named arch, cpu, board, vendor, and soc.
2913
2914 Enabling this option will cause the following to be defined:
2915
2916 - CONFIG_SYS_ARCH
2917 - CONFIG_SYS_CPU
2918 - CONFIG_SYS_BOARD
2919 - CONFIG_SYS_VENDOR
2920 - CONFIG_SYS_SOC
2921
Tom Rini7e27f892012-10-24 07:28:16 +00002922 CONFIG_ENV_VARS_UBOOT_RUNTIME_CONFIG
2923
2924 Define this in order to add variables describing certain
2925 run-time determined information about the hardware to the
2926 environment. These will be named board_name, board_rev.
2927
Simon Glass06fd8532012-11-30 13:01:17 +00002928 CONFIG_DELAY_ENVIRONMENT
2929
2930 Normally the environment is loaded when the board is
2931 intialised so that it is available to U-Boot. This inhibits
2932 that so that the environment is not available until
2933 explicitly loaded later by U-Boot code. With CONFIG_OF_CONTROL
2934 this is instead controlled by the value of
2935 /config/load-environment.
2936
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002937- DataFlash Support:
wdenk2abbe072003-06-16 23:50:08 +00002938 CONFIG_HAS_DATAFLASH
2939
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002940 Defining this option enables DataFlash features and
2941 allows to read/write in Dataflash via the standard
2942 commands cp, md...
wdenk2abbe072003-06-16 23:50:08 +00002943
Eric Nelsonf61ec452012-01-31 10:52:08 -07002944- Serial Flash support
2945 CONFIG_CMD_SF
2946
2947 Defining this option enables SPI flash commands
2948 'sf probe/read/write/erase/update'.
2949
2950 Usage requires an initial 'probe' to define the serial
2951 flash parameters, followed by read/write/erase/update
2952 commands.
2953
2954 The following defaults may be provided by the platform
2955 to handle the common case when only a single serial
2956 flash is present on the system.
2957
2958 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_BUS Bus identifier
2959 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_CS Chip-select
2960 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_MODE (see include/spi.h)
2961 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_SPEED in Hz
2962
Simon Glass24007272012-10-08 13:16:02 +00002963 CONFIG_CMD_SF_TEST
2964
2965 Define this option to include a destructive SPI flash
2966 test ('sf test').
2967
Jagannadha Sutradharudu Teki1dcd6d02013-06-19 15:33:58 +05302968 CONFIG_SPI_FLASH_BAR Ban/Extended Addr Reg
2969
2970 Define this option to use the Bank addr/Extended addr
2971 support on SPI flashes which has size > 16Mbytes.
2972
Jagannadha Sutradharudu Tekib902e072014-01-11 15:25:04 +05302973 CONFIG_SF_DUAL_FLASH Dual flash memories
2974
2975 Define this option to use dual flash support where two flash
2976 memories can be connected with a given cs line.
2977 currently Xilinx Zynq qspi support these type of connections.
2978
Heiko Schocher562f8df2014-07-18 06:07:21 +02002979 CONFIG_SYS_SPI_ST_ENABLE_WP_PIN
2980 enable the W#/Vpp signal to disable writing to the status
2981 register on ST MICRON flashes like the N25Q128.
2982 The status register write enable/disable bit, combined with
2983 the W#/VPP signal provides hardware data protection for the
2984 device as follows: When the enable/disable bit is set to 1,
2985 and the W#/VPP signal is driven LOW, the status register
2986 nonvolatile bits become read-only and the WRITE STATUS REGISTER
2987 operation will not execute. The only way to exit this
2988 hardware-protected mode is to drive W#/VPP HIGH.
2989
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002990- SystemACE Support:
2991 CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
2992
2993 Adding this option adds support for Xilinx SystemACE
2994 chips attached via some sort of local bus. The address
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002995 of the chip must also be defined in the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002996 CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE macro. For example:
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002997
2998 #define CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002999 #define CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE 0xf0000000
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00003000
3001 When SystemACE support is added, the "ace" device type
3002 becomes available to the fat commands, i.e. fatls.
3003
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02003004- TFTP Fixed UDP Port:
3005 CONFIG_TFTP_PORT
3006
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02003007 If this is defined, the environment variable tftpsrcp
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02003008 is used to supply the TFTP UDP source port value.
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02003009 If tftpsrcp isn't defined, the normal pseudo-random port
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02003010 number generator is used.
3011
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02003012 Also, the environment variable tftpdstp is used to supply
3013 the TFTP UDP destination port value. If tftpdstp isn't
3014 defined, the normal port 69 is used.
3015
3016 The purpose for tftpsrcp is to allow a TFTP server to
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02003017 blindly start the TFTP transfer using the pre-configured
3018 target IP address and UDP port. This has the effect of
3019 "punching through" the (Windows XP) firewall, allowing
3020 the remainder of the TFTP transfer to proceed normally.
3021 A better solution is to properly configure the firewall,
3022 but sometimes that is not allowed.
3023
Simon Glassbf36c5d2012-12-05 14:46:38 +00003024- Hashing support:
3025 CONFIG_CMD_HASH
3026
3027 This enables a generic 'hash' command which can produce
3028 hashes / digests from a few algorithms (e.g. SHA1, SHA256).
3029
3030 CONFIG_HASH_VERIFY
3031
3032 Enable the hash verify command (hash -v). This adds to code
3033 size a little.
3034
3035 CONFIG_SHA1 - support SHA1 hashing
3036 CONFIG_SHA256 - support SHA256 hashing
3037
3038 Note: There is also a sha1sum command, which should perhaps
3039 be deprecated in favour of 'hash sha1'.
3040
Robert Winklera11f1872013-07-24 17:57:06 -07003041- Freescale i.MX specific commands:
3042 CONFIG_CMD_HDMIDETECT
3043 This enables 'hdmidet' command which returns true if an
3044 HDMI monitor is detected. This command is i.MX 6 specific.
3045
3046 CONFIG_CMD_BMODE
3047 This enables the 'bmode' (bootmode) command for forcing
3048 a boot from specific media.
3049
3050 This is useful for forcing the ROM's usb downloader to
3051 activate upon a watchdog reset which is nice when iterating
3052 on U-Boot. Using the reset button or running bmode normal
3053 will set it back to normal. This command currently
3054 supports i.MX53 and i.MX6.
3055
Simon Glass19c402a2013-06-13 15:10:02 -07003056- Signing support:
3057 CONFIG_RSA
3058
3059 This enables the RSA algorithm used for FIT image verification
Detlev Zundel8bf2aad2014-01-20 16:21:46 +01003060 in U-Boot. See doc/uImage.FIT/signature.txt for more information.
Simon Glass19c402a2013-06-13 15:10:02 -07003061
3062 The signing part is build into mkimage regardless of this
3063 option.
3064
Heiko Schocher9e50c402014-01-25 07:27:13 +01003065- bootcount support:
3066 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_LIMIT
3067
3068 This enables the bootcounter support, see:
3069 http://www.denx.de/wiki/DULG/UBootBootCountLimit
3070
3071 CONFIG_AT91SAM9XE
3072 enable special bootcounter support on at91sam9xe based boards.
3073 CONFIG_BLACKFIN
3074 enable special bootcounter support on blackfin based boards.
3075 CONFIG_SOC_DA8XX
3076 enable special bootcounter support on da850 based boards.
3077 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_RAM
3078 enable support for the bootcounter in RAM
3079 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_I2C
3080 enable support for the bootcounter on an i2c (like RTC) device.
3081 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_RTC_ADDR = i2c chip address
3082 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTCOUNT_ADDR = i2c addr which is used for
3083 the bootcounter.
3084 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_ALEN = address len
Simon Glass19c402a2013-06-13 15:10:02 -07003085
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00003086- Show boot progress:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003087 CONFIG_SHOW_BOOT_PROGRESS
3088
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003089 Defining this option allows to add some board-
3090 specific code (calling a user-provided function
3091 "show_boot_progress(int)") that enables you to show
3092 the system's boot progress on some display (for
3093 example, some LED's) on your board. At the moment,
3094 the following checkpoints are implemented:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003095
Simon Glass3a608ca2012-02-13 13:51:19 +00003096- Detailed boot stage timing
3097 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE
3098 Define this option to get detailed timing of each stage
3099 of the boot process.
3100
3101 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_USER_COUNT
3102 This is the number of available user bootstage records.
3103 Each time you call bootstage_mark(BOOTSTAGE_ID_ALLOC, ...)
3104 a new ID will be allocated from this stash. If you exceed
3105 the limit, recording will stop.
3106
3107 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_REPORT
3108 Define this to print a report before boot, similar to this:
3109
3110 Timer summary in microseconds:
3111 Mark Elapsed Stage
3112 0 0 reset
3113 3,575,678 3,575,678 board_init_f start
3114 3,575,695 17 arch_cpu_init A9
3115 3,575,777 82 arch_cpu_init done
3116 3,659,598 83,821 board_init_r start
3117 3,910,375 250,777 main_loop
3118 29,916,167 26,005,792 bootm_start
3119 30,361,327 445,160 start_kernel
3120
Simon Glass2eba38c2012-09-28 08:56:39 +00003121 CONFIG_CMD_BOOTSTAGE
3122 Add a 'bootstage' command which supports printing a report
3123 and un/stashing of bootstage data.
3124
Simon Glass94fd1312012-09-28 08:56:37 +00003125 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_FDT
3126 Stash the bootstage information in the FDT. A root 'bootstage'
3127 node is created with each bootstage id as a child. Each child
3128 has a 'name' property and either 'mark' containing the
3129 mark time in microsecond, or 'accum' containing the
3130 accumulated time for that bootstage id in microseconds.
3131 For example:
3132
3133 bootstage {
3134 154 {
3135 name = "board_init_f";
3136 mark = <3575678>;
3137 };
3138 170 {
3139 name = "lcd";
3140 accum = <33482>;
3141 };
3142 };
3143
3144 Code in the Linux kernel can find this in /proc/devicetree.
3145
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003146Legacy uImage format:
3147
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003148 Arg Where When
3149 1 common/cmd_bootm.c before attempting to boot an image
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00003150 -1 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad magic number
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003151 2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct magic number
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00003152 -2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003153 3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct checksum
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00003154 -3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003155 4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has correct checksum
3156 -4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image is for unsupported architecture
3157 5 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003158 -5 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong Image Type (not kernel, multi)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003159 6 common/cmd_bootm.c Image Type check OK
3160 -6 common/cmd_bootm.c gunzip uncompression error
3161 -7 common/cmd_bootm.c Unimplemented compression type
3162 7 common/cmd_bootm.c Uncompression OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003163 8 common/cmd_bootm.c No uncompress/copy overwrite error
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003164 -9 common/cmd_bootm.c Unsupported OS (not Linux, BSD, VxWorks, QNX)
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003165
3166 9 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
3167 -10 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad magic number
3168 -11 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad checksum
3169 10 common/image.c Ramdisk header is OK
3170 -12 common/image.c Ramdisk data has bad checksum
3171 11 common/image.c Ramdisk data has correct checksum
3172 12 common/image.c Ramdisk verification complete, start loading
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003173 -13 common/image.c Wrong Image Type (not PPC Linux ramdisk)
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003174 13 common/image.c Start multifile image verification
3175 14 common/image.c No initial ramdisk, no multifile, continue.
3176
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003177 15 arch/<arch>/lib/bootm.c All preparation done, transferring control to OS
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003178
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02003179 -30 arch/powerpc/lib/board.c Fatal error, hang the system
wdenk11dadd52004-02-27 00:07:27 +00003180 -31 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_output_backlog()
3181 -32 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_run_single()
wdenk63e73c92004-02-23 22:22:28 +00003182
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003183 34 common/cmd_doc.c before loading a Image from a DOC device
3184 -35 common/cmd_doc.c Bad usage of "doc" command
3185 35 common/cmd_doc.c correct usage of "doc" command
3186 -36 common/cmd_doc.c No boot device
3187 36 common/cmd_doc.c correct boot device
3188 -37 common/cmd_doc.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
3189 37 common/cmd_doc.c correct chip ID found, device available
3190 -38 common/cmd_doc.c Read Error on boot device
3191 38 common/cmd_doc.c reading Image header from DOC device OK
3192 -39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has bad magic number
3193 39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
3194 -40 common/cmd_doc.c Error reading Image from DOC device
3195 40 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
3196 41 common/cmd_ide.c before loading a Image from a IDE device
3197 -42 common/cmd_ide.c Bad usage of "ide" command
3198 42 common/cmd_ide.c correct usage of "ide" command
3199 -43 common/cmd_ide.c No boot device
3200 43 common/cmd_ide.c boot device found
3201 -44 common/cmd_ide.c Device not available
3202 44 common/cmd_ide.c Device available
3203 -45 common/cmd_ide.c wrong partition selected
3204 45 common/cmd_ide.c partition selected
3205 -46 common/cmd_ide.c Unknown partition table
3206 46 common/cmd_ide.c valid partition table found
3207 -47 common/cmd_ide.c Invalid partition type
3208 47 common/cmd_ide.c correct partition type
3209 -48 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
3210 48 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image Header from IDE device OK
3211 -49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad magic number
3212 49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct magic number
3213 -50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad checksum
3214 50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct checksum
3215 -51 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image from IDE device
3216 51 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image from IDE device OK
3217 52 common/cmd_nand.c before loading a Image from a NAND device
3218 -53 common/cmd_nand.c Bad usage of "nand" command
3219 53 common/cmd_nand.c correct usage of "nand" command
3220 -54 common/cmd_nand.c No boot device
3221 54 common/cmd_nand.c boot device found
3222 -55 common/cmd_nand.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
3223 55 common/cmd_nand.c correct chip ID found, device available
3224 -56 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
3225 56 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image Header from NAND device OK
3226 -57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has bad magic number
3227 57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has correct magic number
3228 -58 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image from NAND device
3229 58 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image from NAND device OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003230
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003231 -60 common/env_common.c Environment has a bad CRC, using default
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003232
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003233 64 net/eth.c starting with Ethernet configuration.
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003234 -64 net/eth.c no Ethernet found.
3235 65 net/eth.c Ethernet found.
wdenk206c60c2003-09-18 10:02:25 +00003236
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003237 -80 common/cmd_net.c usage wrong
3238 80 common/cmd_net.c before calling NetLoop()
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003239 -81 common/cmd_net.c some error in NetLoop() occurred
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003240 81 common/cmd_net.c NetLoop() back without error
3241 -82 common/cmd_net.c size == 0 (File with size 0 loaded)
3242 82 common/cmd_net.c trying automatic boot
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02003243 83 common/cmd_net.c running "source" command
3244 -83 common/cmd_net.c some error in automatic boot or "source" command
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003245 84 common/cmd_net.c end without errors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003246
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003247FIT uImage format:
3248
3249 Arg Where When
3250 100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has correct format
3251 -100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has incorrect format
3252 101 common/cmd_bootm.c No Kernel subimage unit name, using configuration
3253 -101 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get configuration for kernel subimage
3254 102 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel unit name specified
3255 -103 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage node offset
Marian Balakowiczf773bea2008-03-12 10:35:46 +01003256 103 common/cmd_bootm.c Found configuration node
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003257 104 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage node offset
3258 -104 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification failed
3259 105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification OK
3260 -105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage is for unsupported architecture
3261 106 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003262 -106 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage has wrong type
3263 107 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage type OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003264 -107 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage data/size
3265 108 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage data/size
3266 -108 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong image type (not legacy, FIT)
3267 -109 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage type
3268 -110 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage comp
3269 -111 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage os
3270 -112 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage load address
3271 -113 common/cmd_bootm.c Image uncompress/copy overwrite error
3272
3273 120 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
3274 -120 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has incorrect format
3275 121 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has correct format
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003276 122 common/image.c No ramdisk subimage unit name, using configuration
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003277 -122 common/image.c Can't get configuration for ramdisk subimage
3278 123 common/image.c Ramdisk unit name specified
3279 -124 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage node offset
3280 125 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage node offset
3281 -125 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification failed
3282 126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification OK
3283 -126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage for unsupported architecture
3284 127 common/image.c Architecture check OK
3285 -127 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage data/size
3286 128 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage data/size
3287 129 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk load address
3288 -129 common/image.c Got ramdisk load address
3289
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003290 -130 common/cmd_doc.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003291 131 common/cmd_doc.c FIT image format OK
3292
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003293 -140 common/cmd_ide.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003294 141 common/cmd_ide.c FIT image format OK
3295
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003296 -150 common/cmd_nand.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003297 151 common/cmd_nand.c FIT image format OK
3298
Heiko Schocher21d29f72014-05-28 11:33:33 +02003299- legacy image format:
3300 CONFIG_IMAGE_FORMAT_LEGACY
3301 enables the legacy image format support in U-Boot.
3302
3303 Default:
3304 enabled if CONFIG_FIT_SIGNATURE is not defined.
3305
3306 CONFIG_DISABLE_IMAGE_LEGACY
3307 disable the legacy image format
3308
3309 This define is introduced, as the legacy image format is
3310 enabled per default for backward compatibility.
3311
Gabe Blackd95f6ec2012-10-25 16:31:10 +00003312- FIT image support:
3313 CONFIG_FIT
3314 Enable support for the FIT uImage format.
3315
3316 CONFIG_FIT_BEST_MATCH
3317 When no configuration is explicitly selected, default to the
3318 one whose fdt's compatibility field best matches that of
3319 U-Boot itself. A match is considered "best" if it matches the
3320 most specific compatibility entry of U-Boot's fdt's root node.
3321 The order of entries in the configuration's fdt is ignored.
3322
Simon Glass3e569a62013-06-13 15:10:00 -07003323 CONFIG_FIT_SIGNATURE
3324 This option enables signature verification of FIT uImages,
3325 using a hash signed and verified using RSA. See
3326 doc/uImage.FIT/signature.txt for more details.
3327
Heiko Schocher21d29f72014-05-28 11:33:33 +02003328 WARNING: When relying on signed FIT images with required
3329 signature check the legacy image format is default
3330 disabled. If a board need legacy image format support
3331 enable this through CONFIG_IMAGE_FORMAT_LEGACY
3332
Dirk Eibach9a4f4792014-07-03 09:28:26 +02003333 CONFIG_FIT_DISABLE_SHA256
3334 Supporting SHA256 hashes has quite an impact on binary size.
3335 For constrained systems sha256 hash support can be disabled
3336 with this option.
3337
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02003338- Standalone program support:
3339 CONFIG_STANDALONE_LOAD_ADDR
3340
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +02003341 This option defines a board specific value for the
3342 address where standalone program gets loaded, thus
3343 overwriting the architecture dependent default
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02003344 settings.
3345
3346- Frame Buffer Address:
3347 CONFIG_FB_ADDR
3348
3349 Define CONFIG_FB_ADDR if you want to use specific
Wolfgang Denk44a53b52013-01-03 00:43:59 +00003350 address for frame buffer. This is typically the case
3351 when using a graphics controller has separate video
3352 memory. U-Boot will then place the frame buffer at
3353 the given address instead of dynamically reserving it
3354 in system RAM by calling lcd_setmem(), which grabs
3355 the memory for the frame buffer depending on the
3356 configured panel size.
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02003357
3358 Please see board_init_f function.
3359
Detlev Zundelcccfc2a2009-12-01 17:16:19 +01003360- Automatic software updates via TFTP server
3361 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP
3362 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_CNT_MAX
3363 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_MSEC_MAX
3364
3365 These options enable and control the auto-update feature;
3366 for a more detailed description refer to doc/README.update.
3367
3368- MTD Support (mtdparts command, UBI support)
3369 CONFIG_MTD_DEVICE
3370
3371 Adds the MTD device infrastructure from the Linux kernel.
3372 Needed for mtdparts command support.
3373
3374 CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS
3375
3376 Adds the MTD partitioning infrastructure from the Linux
3377 kernel. Needed for UBI support.
3378
Heiko Schocherff94bc42014-06-24 10:10:04 +02003379 CONFIG_MTD_NAND_VERIFY_WRITE
3380 verify if the written data is correct reread.
3381
Joe Hershberger70c219c2013-04-08 10:32:48 +00003382- UBI support
3383 CONFIG_CMD_UBI
3384
3385 Adds commands for interacting with MTD partitions formatted
3386 with the UBI flash translation layer
3387
3388 Requires also defining CONFIG_RBTREE
3389
Joe Hershberger147162d2013-04-08 10:32:49 +00003390 CONFIG_UBI_SILENCE_MSG
3391
3392 Make the verbose messages from UBI stop printing. This leaves
3393 warnings and errors enabled.
3394
Heiko Schocherff94bc42014-06-24 10:10:04 +02003395
3396 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_WL_THRESHOLD
3397 This parameter defines the maximum difference between the highest
3398 erase counter value and the lowest erase counter value of eraseblocks
3399 of UBI devices. When this threshold is exceeded, UBI starts performing
3400 wear leveling by means of moving data from eraseblock with low erase
3401 counter to eraseblocks with high erase counter.
3402
3403 The default value should be OK for SLC NAND flashes, NOR flashes and
3404 other flashes which have eraseblock life-cycle 100000 or more.
3405 However, in case of MLC NAND flashes which typically have eraseblock
3406 life-cycle less than 10000, the threshold should be lessened (e.g.,
3407 to 128 or 256, although it does not have to be power of 2).
3408
3409 default: 4096
3410
3411 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_BEB_LIMIT
3412 This option specifies the maximum bad physical eraseblocks UBI
3413 expects on the MTD device (per 1024 eraseblocks). If the
3414 underlying flash does not admit of bad eraseblocks (e.g. NOR
3415 flash), this value is ignored.
3416
3417 NAND datasheets often specify the minimum and maximum NVM
3418 (Number of Valid Blocks) for the flashes' endurance lifetime.
3419 The maximum expected bad eraseblocks per 1024 eraseblocks
3420 then can be calculated as "1024 * (1 - MinNVB / MaxNVB)",
3421 which gives 20 for most NANDs (MaxNVB is basically the total
3422 count of eraseblocks on the chip).
3423
3424 To put it differently, if this value is 20, UBI will try to
3425 reserve about 1.9% of physical eraseblocks for bad blocks
3426 handling. And that will be 1.9% of eraseblocks on the entire
3427 NAND chip, not just the MTD partition UBI attaches. This means
3428 that if you have, say, a NAND flash chip admits maximum 40 bad
3429 eraseblocks, and it is split on two MTD partitions of the same
3430 size, UBI will reserve 40 eraseblocks when attaching a
3431 partition.
3432
3433 default: 20
3434
3435 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_FASTMAP
3436 Fastmap is a mechanism which allows attaching an UBI device
3437 in nearly constant time. Instead of scanning the whole MTD device it
3438 only has to locate a checkpoint (called fastmap) on the device.
3439 The on-flash fastmap contains all information needed to attach
3440 the device. Using fastmap makes only sense on large devices where
3441 attaching by scanning takes long. UBI will not automatically install
3442 a fastmap on old images, but you can set the UBI parameter
3443 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_FASTMAP_AUTOCONVERT to 1 if you want so. Please note
3444 that fastmap-enabled images are still usable with UBI implementations
3445 without fastmap support. On typical flash devices the whole fastmap
3446 fits into one PEB. UBI will reserve PEBs to hold two fastmaps.
3447
3448 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_FASTMAP_AUTOCONVERT
3449 Set this parameter to enable fastmap automatically on images
3450 without a fastmap.
3451 default: 0
3452
Joe Hershberger70c219c2013-04-08 10:32:48 +00003453- UBIFS support
3454 CONFIG_CMD_UBIFS
3455
3456 Adds commands for interacting with UBI volumes formatted as
3457 UBIFS. UBIFS is read-only in u-boot.
3458
3459 Requires UBI support as well as CONFIG_LZO
3460
Joe Hershberger147162d2013-04-08 10:32:49 +00003461 CONFIG_UBIFS_SILENCE_MSG
3462
3463 Make the verbose messages from UBIFS stop printing. This leaves
3464 warnings and errors enabled.
3465
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003466- SPL framework
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003467 CONFIG_SPL
3468 Enable building of SPL globally.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003469
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003470 CONFIG_SPL_LDSCRIPT
3471 LDSCRIPT for linking the SPL binary.
3472
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003473 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_FOOTPRINT
3474 Maximum size in memory allocated to the SPL, BSS included.
3475 When defined, the linker checks that the actual memory
3476 used by SPL from _start to __bss_end does not exceed it.
Albert ARIBAUD8960af82013-04-14 04:48:38 +00003477 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_FOOTPRINT and CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003478 must not be both defined at the same time.
3479
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003480 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003481 Maximum size of the SPL image (text, data, rodata, and
3482 linker lists sections), BSS excluded.
3483 When defined, the linker checks that the actual size does
3484 not exceed it.
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003485
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003486 CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE
3487 TEXT_BASE for linking the SPL binary.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003488
Scott Wood94a45bb2012-09-20 19:05:12 -05003489 CONFIG_SPL_RELOC_TEXT_BASE
3490 Address to relocate to. If unspecified, this is equal to
3491 CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE (i.e. no relocation is done).
3492
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003493 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_START_ADDR
3494 Link address for the BSS within the SPL binary.
3495
3496 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003497 Maximum size in memory allocated to the SPL BSS.
3498 When defined, the linker checks that the actual memory used
3499 by SPL from __bss_start to __bss_end does not exceed it.
Albert ARIBAUD8960af82013-04-14 04:48:38 +00003500 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_FOOTPRINT and CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003501 must not be both defined at the same time.
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003502
3503 CONFIG_SPL_STACK
3504 Adress of the start of the stack SPL will use
3505
Scott Wood94a45bb2012-09-20 19:05:12 -05003506 CONFIG_SPL_RELOC_STACK
3507 Adress of the start of the stack SPL will use after
3508 relocation. If unspecified, this is equal to
3509 CONFIG_SPL_STACK.
3510
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003511 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_START
3512 Starting address of the malloc pool used in SPL.
3513
3514 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_SIZE
3515 The size of the malloc pool used in SPL.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003516
Tom Rini47f7bca2012-08-13 12:03:19 -07003517 CONFIG_SPL_FRAMEWORK
3518 Enable the SPL framework under common/. This framework
3519 supports MMC, NAND and YMODEM loading of U-Boot and NAND
3520 NAND loading of the Linux Kernel.
3521
Tom Rini9607faf2014-03-28 12:03:39 -04003522 CONFIG_SPL_OS_BOOT
3523 Enable booting directly to an OS from SPL.
3524 See also: doc/README.falcon
3525
Tom Rini861a86f2012-08-13 11:37:56 -07003526 CONFIG_SPL_DISPLAY_PRINT
3527 For ARM, enable an optional function to print more information
3528 about the running system.
3529
Scott Wood4b919722012-09-20 16:35:21 -05003530 CONFIG_SPL_INIT_MINIMAL
3531 Arch init code should be built for a very small image
3532
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003533 CONFIG_SPL_LIBCOMMON_SUPPORT
3534 Support for common/libcommon.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003535
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003536 CONFIG_SPL_LIBDISK_SUPPORT
3537 Support for disk/libdisk.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003538
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003539 CONFIG_SPL_I2C_SUPPORT
3540 Support for drivers/i2c/libi2c.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003541
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003542 CONFIG_SPL_GPIO_SUPPORT
3543 Support for drivers/gpio/libgpio.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003544
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003545 CONFIG_SPL_MMC_SUPPORT
3546 Support for drivers/mmc/libmmc.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003547
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003548 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_U_BOOT_SECTOR,
3549 CONFIG_SYS_U_BOOT_MAX_SIZE_SECTORS,
3550 CONFIG_SYS_MMC_SD_FAT_BOOT_PARTITION
3551 Address, size and partition on the MMC to load U-Boot from
3552 when the MMC is being used in raw mode.
3553
Peter Korsgaard2b75b0a2013-05-13 08:36:29 +00003554 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_KERNEL_SECTOR
3555 Sector to load kernel uImage from when MMC is being
3556 used in raw mode (for Falcon mode)
3557
3558 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_ARGS_SECTOR,
3559 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_ARGS_SECTORS
3560 Sector and number of sectors to load kernel argument
3561 parameters from when MMC is being used in raw mode
3562 (for falcon mode)
3563
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003564 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_SUPPORT
3565 Support for fs/fat/libfat.o in SPL binary
3566
3567 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_LOAD_PAYLOAD_NAME
3568 Filename to read to load U-Boot when reading from FAT
3569
Peter Korsgaard7ad2cc72013-05-13 08:36:27 +00003570 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_LOAD_KERNEL_NAME
3571 Filename to read to load kernel uImage when reading
3572 from FAT (for Falcon mode)
3573
3574 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_LOAD_ARGS_NAME
3575 Filename to read to load kernel argument parameters
3576 when reading from FAT (for Falcon mode)
3577
Scott Wood06f60ae2012-12-06 13:33:17 +00003578 CONFIG_SPL_MPC83XX_WAIT_FOR_NAND
3579 Set this for NAND SPL on PPC mpc83xx targets, so that
3580 start.S waits for the rest of the SPL to load before
3581 continuing (the hardware starts execution after just
3582 loading the first page rather than the full 4K).
3583
Prabhakar Kushwaha651fcf62014-04-08 19:12:31 +05303584 CONFIG_SPL_SKIP_RELOCATE
3585 Avoid SPL relocation
3586
Scott Wood6f2f01b2012-09-20 19:09:07 -05003587 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_BASE
3588 Include nand_base.c in the SPL. Requires
3589 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_DRIVERS.
3590
3591 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_DRIVERS
3592 SPL uses normal NAND drivers, not minimal drivers.
3593
3594 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_ECC
3595 Include standard software ECC in the SPL
3596
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003597 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_SIMPLE
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05003598 Support for NAND boot using simple NAND drivers that
3599 expose the cmd_ctrl() interface.
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003600
Tom Rini6dd3b562014-03-28 12:03:36 -04003601 CONFIG_SPL_MTD_SUPPORT
3602 Support for the MTD subsystem within SPL. Useful for
3603 environment on NAND support within SPL.
3604
Ying Zhangbb0dc102013-08-16 15:16:11 +08003605 CONFIG_SPL_MPC8XXX_INIT_DDR_SUPPORT
3606 Set for the SPL on PPC mpc8xxx targets, support for
York Sun5614e712013-09-30 09:22:09 -07003607 drivers/ddr/fsl/libddr.o in SPL binary.
Ying Zhangbb0dc102013-08-16 15:16:11 +08003608
Ying Zhang7c8eea52013-08-16 15:16:12 +08003609 CONFIG_SPL_COMMON_INIT_DDR
3610 Set for common ddr init with serial presence detect in
3611 SPL binary.
3612
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003613 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_5_ADDR_CYCLE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_COUNT,
3614 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_OOBSIZE,
3615 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BLOCK_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BAD_BLOCK_POS,
3616 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCPOS, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCSIZE,
3617 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCBYTES
3618 Defines the size and behavior of the NAND that SPL uses
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05003619 to read U-Boot
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003620
Prabhakar Kushwahafbe76ae2013-12-11 12:42:11 +05303621 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_BOOT
3622 Add support NAND boot
3623
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003624 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_OFFS
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05003625 Location in NAND to read U-Boot from
3626
3627 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_DST
3628 Location in memory to load U-Boot to
3629
3630 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_SIZE
3631 Size of image to load
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003632
3633 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_START
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05003634 Entry point in loaded image to jump to
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003635
3636 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_HW_ECC_OOBFIRST
3637 Define this if you need to first read the OOB and then the
3638 data. This is used for example on davinci plattforms.
3639
3640 CONFIG_SPL_OMAP3_ID_NAND
3641 Support for an OMAP3-specific set of functions to return the
3642 ID and MFR of the first attached NAND chip, if present.
3643
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003644 CONFIG_SPL_SERIAL_SUPPORT
3645 Support for drivers/serial/libserial.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003646
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003647 CONFIG_SPL_SPI_FLASH_SUPPORT
3648 Support for drivers/mtd/spi/libspi_flash.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003649
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003650 CONFIG_SPL_SPI_SUPPORT
3651 Support for drivers/spi/libspi.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003652
Pavel Machekc57b9532012-08-30 22:42:11 +02003653 CONFIG_SPL_RAM_DEVICE
3654 Support for running image already present in ram, in SPL binary
3655
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003656 CONFIG_SPL_LIBGENERIC_SUPPORT
3657 Support for lib/libgeneric.o in SPL binary
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003658
Ying Zhangba1bee42013-05-20 14:07:25 +08003659 CONFIG_SPL_ENV_SUPPORT
3660 Support for the environment operating in SPL binary
3661
3662 CONFIG_SPL_NET_SUPPORT
3663 Support for the net/libnet.o in SPL binary.
3664 It conflicts with SPL env from storage medium specified by
3665 CONFIG_ENV_IS_xxx but CONFIG_ENV_IS_NOWHERE
3666
Scott Wood74752ba2012-12-06 13:33:16 +00003667 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO
Benoît Thébaudeau6113d3f2013-04-11 09:35:49 +00003668 Image offset to which the SPL should be padded before appending
3669 the SPL payload. By default, this is defined as
3670 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE, or 0 if CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE is undefined.
3671 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO must be either 0, meaning to append the SPL
3672 payload without any padding, or >= CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE.
Scott Wood74752ba2012-12-06 13:33:16 +00003673
Scott Woodca2fca22012-09-21 16:27:32 -05003674 CONFIG_SPL_TARGET
3675 Final target image containing SPL and payload. Some SPLs
3676 use an arch-specific makefile fragment instead, for
3677 example if more than one image needs to be produced.
3678
Simon Glass87ebee32013-05-08 08:05:59 +00003679 CONFIG_FIT_SPL_PRINT
3680 Printing information about a FIT image adds quite a bit of
3681 code to SPL. So this is normally disabled in SPL. Use this
3682 option to re-enable it. This will affect the output of the
3683 bootm command when booting a FIT image.
3684
Ying Zhang3aa29de2013-08-16 15:16:15 +08003685- TPL framework
3686 CONFIG_TPL
3687 Enable building of TPL globally.
3688
3689 CONFIG_TPL_PAD_TO
3690 Image offset to which the TPL should be padded before appending
3691 the TPL payload. By default, this is defined as
Wolfgang Denk93e14592013-10-04 17:43:24 +02003692 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE, or 0 if CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE is undefined.
3693 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO must be either 0, meaning to append the SPL
3694 payload without any padding, or >= CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE.
Ying Zhang3aa29de2013-08-16 15:16:15 +08003695
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003696Modem Support:
3697--------------
3698
Wolfgang Denk566e5cf2011-05-01 20:44:23 +02003699[so far only for SMDK2400 boards]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003700
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003701- Modem support enable:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003702 CONFIG_MODEM_SUPPORT
3703
3704- RTS/CTS Flow control enable:
3705 CONFIG_HWFLOW
3706
3707- Modem debug support:
3708 CONFIG_MODEM_SUPPORT_DEBUG
3709
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003710 Enables debugging stuff (char screen[1024], dbg())
3711 for modem support. Useful only with BDI2000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003712
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00003713- Interrupt support (PPC):
3714
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003715 There are common interrupt_init() and timer_interrupt()
3716 for all PPC archs. interrupt_init() calls interrupt_init_cpu()
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003717 for CPU specific initialization. interrupt_init_cpu()
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003718 should set decrementer_count to appropriate value. If
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003719 CPU resets decrementer automatically after interrupt
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003720 (ppc4xx) it should set decrementer_count to zero.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003721 timer_interrupt() calls timer_interrupt_cpu() for CPU
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003722 specific handling. If board has watchdog / status_led
3723 / other_activity_monitor it works automatically from
3724 general timer_interrupt().
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00003725
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003726- General:
3727
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003728 In the target system modem support is enabled when a
3729 specific key (key combination) is pressed during
3730 power-on. Otherwise U-Boot will boot normally
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003731 (autoboot). The key_pressed() function is called from
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003732 board_init(). Currently key_pressed() is a dummy
3733 function, returning 1 and thus enabling modem
3734 initialization.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003735
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003736 If there are no modem init strings in the
3737 environment, U-Boot proceed to autoboot; the
3738 previous output (banner, info printfs) will be
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003739 suppressed, though.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003740
3741 See also: doc/README.Modem
3742
Helmut Raiger9660e442011-10-20 04:19:47 +00003743Board initialization settings:
3744------------------------------
3745
3746During Initialization u-boot calls a number of board specific functions
3747to allow the preparation of board specific prerequisites, e.g. pin setup
3748before drivers are initialized. To enable these callbacks the
3749following configuration macros have to be defined. Currently this is
3750architecture specific, so please check arch/your_architecture/lib/board.c
3751typically in board_init_f() and board_init_r().
3752
3753- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_F: Call board_early_init_f()
3754- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_R: Call board_early_init_r()
3755- CONFIG_BOARD_LATE_INIT: Call board_late_init()
3756- CONFIG_BOARD_POSTCLK_INIT: Call board_postclk_init()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003757
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003758Configuration Settings:
3759-----------------------
3760
York Sun4d1fd7f2014-02-26 17:03:19 -08003761- CONFIG_SYS_SUPPORT_64BIT_DATA: Defined automatically if compiled as 64-bit.
3762 Optionally it can be defined to support 64-bit memory commands.
3763
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003764- CONFIG_SYS_LONGHELP: Defined when you want long help messages included;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003765 undefine this when you're short of memory.
3766
Peter Tyser2fb26042009-01-27 18:03:12 -06003767- CONFIG_SYS_HELP_CMD_WIDTH: Defined when you want to override the default
3768 width of the commands listed in the 'help' command output.
3769
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003770- CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT: This is what U-Boot prints on the console to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003771 prompt for user input.
3772
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003773- CONFIG_SYS_CBSIZE: Buffer size for input from the Console
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003774
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003775- CONFIG_SYS_PBSIZE: Buffer size for Console output
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003776
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003777- CONFIG_SYS_MAXARGS: max. Number of arguments accepted for monitor commands
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003778
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003779- CONFIG_SYS_BARGSIZE: Buffer size for Boot Arguments which are passed to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003780 the application (usually a Linux kernel) when it is
3781 booted
3782
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003783- CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003784 List of legal baudrate settings for this board.
3785
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003786- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_INFO_QUIET
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003787 Suppress display of console information at boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003788
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003789- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003790 If the board specific function
3791 extern int overwrite_console (void);
3792 returns 1, the stdin, stderr and stdout are switched to the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003793 serial port, else the settings in the environment are used.
3794
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003795- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_OVERWRITE_ROUTINE
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003796 Enable the call to overwrite_console().
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003797
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003798- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_ENV_OVERWRITE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003799 Enable overwrite of previous console environment settings.
3800
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003801- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_START, CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_END:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003802 Begin and End addresses of the area used by the
3803 simple memory test.
3804
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003805- CONFIG_SYS_ALT_MEMTEST:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003806 Enable an alternate, more extensive memory test.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003807
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003808- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_SCRATCH:
wdenk5f535fe2003-09-18 09:21:33 +00003809 Scratch address used by the alternate memory test
3810 You only need to set this if address zero isn't writeable
3811
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003812- CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE (PPC only):
3813 If CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE is defined in the board config header,
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003814 this specified memory area will get subtracted from the top
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003815 (end) of RAM and won't get "touched" at all by U-Boot. By
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003816 fixing up gd->ram_size the Linux kernel should gets passed
3817 the now "corrected" memory size and won't touch it either.
3818 This should work for arch/ppc and arch/powerpc. Only Linux
Stefan Roese5e12e752008-03-28 11:02:53 +01003819 board ports in arch/powerpc with bootwrapper support that
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003820 recalculate the memory size from the SDRAM controller setup
Stefan Roese5e12e752008-03-28 11:02:53 +01003821 will have to get fixed in Linux additionally.
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003822
3823 This option can be used as a workaround for the 440EPx/GRx
3824 CHIP 11 errata where the last 256 bytes in SDRAM shouldn't
3825 be touched.
3826
3827 WARNING: Please make sure that this value is a multiple of
3828 the Linux page size (normally 4k). If this is not the case,
3829 then the end address of the Linux memory will be located at a
3830 non page size aligned address and this could cause major
3831 problems.
3832
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003833- CONFIG_SYS_LOADS_BAUD_CHANGE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003834 Enable temporary baudrate change while serial download
3835
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003836- CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003837 Physical start address of SDRAM. _Must_ be 0 here.
3838
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003839- CONFIG_SYS_MBIO_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003840 Physical start address of Motherboard I/O (if using a
3841 Cogent motherboard)
3842
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003843- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003844 Physical start address of Flash memory.
3845
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003846- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003847 Physical start address of boot monitor code (set by
3848 make config files to be same as the text base address
Wolfgang Denk14d0a022010-10-07 21:51:12 +02003849 (CONFIG_SYS_TEXT_BASE) used when linking) - same as
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003850 CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE when booting from flash.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003851
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003852- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_LEN:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003853 Size of memory reserved for monitor code, used to
3854 determine _at_compile_time_ (!) if the environment is
3855 embedded within the U-Boot image, or in a separate
3856 flash sector.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003857
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003858- CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003859 Size of DRAM reserved for malloc() use.
3860
Simon Glassd59476b2014-07-10 22:23:28 -06003861- CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_F_LEN
3862 Size of the malloc() pool for use before relocation. If
3863 this is defined, then a very simple malloc() implementation
3864 will become available before relocation. The address is just
3865 below the global data, and the stack is moved down to make
3866 space.
3867
3868 This feature allocates regions with increasing addresses
3869 within the region. calloc() is supported, but realloc()
3870 is not available. free() is supported but does nothing.
3871 The memory will be freed (or in fact just forgotton) when
3872 U-Boot relocates itself.
3873
Simon Glasse7b14e92014-09-15 06:33:18 -06003874 Pre-relocation malloc() is only supported on ARM and sandbox
Simon Glass29afe9e2014-07-10 22:23:31 -06003875 at present but is fairly easy to enable for other archs.
3876
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003877- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN:
Stefan Roese15940c92006-03-13 11:16:36 +01003878 Normally compressed uImages are limited to an
3879 uncompressed size of 8 MBytes. If this is not enough,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003880 you can define CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN in your board config file
Stefan Roese15940c92006-03-13 11:16:36 +01003881 to adjust this setting to your needs.
3882
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003883- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003884 Maximum size of memory mapped by the startup code of
3885 the Linux kernel; all data that must be processed by
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02003886 the Linux kernel (bd_info, boot arguments, FDT blob if
3887 used) must be put below this limit, unless "bootm_low"
Robert P. J. Day1bce2ae2013-09-16 07:15:45 -04003888 environment variable is defined and non-zero. In such case
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02003889 all data for the Linux kernel must be between "bootm_low"
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003890 and "bootm_low" + CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. The environment
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00003891 variable "bootm_mapsize" will override the value of
3892 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. If CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is undefined,
3893 then the value in "bootm_size" will be used instead.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003894
John Rigbyfca43cc2010-10-13 13:57:35 -06003895- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_RAMDISK_HIGH:
3896 Enable initrd_high functionality. If defined then the
3897 initrd_high feature is enabled and the bootm ramdisk subcommand
3898 is enabled.
3899
3900- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_CMDLINE:
3901 Enables allocating and saving kernel cmdline in space between
3902 "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
3903
3904- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_KBD:
3905 Enables allocating and saving a kernel copy of the bd_info in
3906 space between "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
3907
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003908- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003909 Max number of Flash memory banks
3910
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003911- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_SECT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003912 Max number of sectors on a Flash chip
3913
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003914- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_ERASE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003915 Timeout for Flash erase operations (in ms)
3916
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003917- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_WRITE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003918 Timeout for Flash write operations (in ms)
3919
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003920- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_LOCK_TOUT
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00003921 Timeout for Flash set sector lock bit operation (in ms)
3922
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003923- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_UNLOCK_TOUT
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00003924 Timeout for Flash clear lock bits operation (in ms)
3925
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003926- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_PROTECTION
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00003927 If defined, hardware flash sectors protection is used
3928 instead of U-Boot software protection.
3929
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003930- CONFIG_SYS_DIRECT_FLASH_TFTP:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003931
3932 Enable TFTP transfers directly to flash memory;
3933 without this option such a download has to be
3934 performed in two steps: (1) download to RAM, and (2)
3935 copy from RAM to flash.
3936
3937 The two-step approach is usually more reliable, since
3938 you can check if the download worked before you erase
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003939 the flash, but in some situations (when system RAM is
3940 too limited to allow for a temporary copy of the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003941 downloaded image) this option may be very useful.
3942
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003943- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_CFI:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003944 Define if the flash driver uses extra elements in the
wdenk5653fc32004-02-08 22:55:38 +00003945 common flash structure for storing flash geometry.
3946
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD00b18832008-08-13 01:40:42 +02003947- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_DRIVER
wdenk5653fc32004-02-08 22:55:38 +00003948 This option also enables the building of the cfi_flash driver
3949 in the drivers directory
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003950
Piotr Ziecik91809ed2008-11-17 15:57:58 +01003951- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_MTD
3952 This option enables the building of the cfi_mtd driver
3953 in the drivers directory. The driver exports CFI flash
3954 to the MTD layer.
3955
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003956- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_USE_BUFFER_WRITE
Guennadi Liakhovetski96ef8312008-04-03 13:36:02 +02003957 Use buffered writes to flash.
3958
3959- CONFIG_FLASH_SPANSION_S29WS_N
3960 s29ws-n MirrorBit flash has non-standard addresses for buffered
3961 write commands.
3962
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003963- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_QUIET_TEST
Stefan Roese5568e612005-11-22 13:20:42 +01003964 If this option is defined, the common CFI flash doesn't
3965 print it's warning upon not recognized FLASH banks. This
3966 is useful, if some of the configured banks are only
3967 optionally available.
3968
Jerry Van Baren9a042e92008-03-08 13:48:01 -05003969- CONFIG_FLASH_SHOW_PROGRESS
3970 If defined (must be an integer), print out countdown
3971 digits and dots. Recommended value: 45 (9..1) for 80
3972 column displays, 15 (3..1) for 40 column displays.
3973
Stefan Roese352ef3f2013-04-04 15:53:14 +02003974- CONFIG_FLASH_VERIFY
3975 If defined, the content of the flash (destination) is compared
3976 against the source after the write operation. An error message
3977 will be printed when the contents are not identical.
3978 Please note that this option is useless in nearly all cases,
3979 since such flash programming errors usually are detected earlier
3980 while unprotecting/erasing/programming. Please only enable
3981 this option if you really know what you are doing.
3982
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003983- CONFIG_SYS_RX_ETH_BUFFER:
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003984 Defines the number of Ethernet receive buffers. On some
3985 Ethernet controllers it is recommended to set this value
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00003986 to 8 or even higher (EEPRO100 or 405 EMAC), since all
3987 buffers can be full shortly after enabling the interface
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003988 on high Ethernet traffic.
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00003989 Defaults to 4 if not defined.
3990
Wolfgang Denkea882ba2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02003991- CONFIG_ENV_MAX_ENTRIES
3992
Wolfgang Denk071bc922010-10-27 22:48:30 +02003993 Maximum number of entries in the hash table that is used
3994 internally to store the environment settings. The default
3995 setting is supposed to be generous and should work in most
3996 cases. This setting can be used to tune behaviour; see
3997 lib/hashtable.c for details.
Wolfgang Denkea882ba2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02003998
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06003999- CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_DEFAULT
4000- CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC
Robert P. J. Day1bce2ae2013-09-16 07:15:45 -04004001 Enable validation of the values given to environment variables when
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06004002 calling env set. Variables can be restricted to only decimal,
4003 hexadecimal, or boolean. If CONFIG_CMD_NET is also defined,
4004 the variables can also be restricted to IP address or MAC address.
4005
4006 The format of the list is:
4007 type_attribute = [s|d|x|b|i|m]
Joe Hershberger267541f2012-12-11 22:16:34 -06004008 access_atribute = [a|r|o|c]
4009 attributes = type_attribute[access_atribute]
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06004010 entry = variable_name[:attributes]
4011 list = entry[,list]
4012
4013 The type attributes are:
4014 s - String (default)
4015 d - Decimal
4016 x - Hexadecimal
4017 b - Boolean ([1yYtT|0nNfF])
4018 i - IP address
4019 m - MAC address
4020
Joe Hershberger267541f2012-12-11 22:16:34 -06004021 The access attributes are:
4022 a - Any (default)
4023 r - Read-only
4024 o - Write-once
4025 c - Change-default
4026
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06004027 - CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_DEFAULT
4028 Define this to a list (string) to define the ".flags"
4029 envirnoment variable in the default or embedded environment.
4030
4031 - CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC
4032 Define this to a list (string) to define validation that
4033 should be done if an entry is not found in the ".flags"
4034 environment variable. To override a setting in the static
4035 list, simply add an entry for the same variable name to the
4036 ".flags" variable.
4037
Joe Hershberger267541f2012-12-11 22:16:34 -06004038- CONFIG_ENV_ACCESS_IGNORE_FORCE
4039 If defined, don't allow the -f switch to env set override variable
4040 access flags.
4041
Simon Glass5c1a7ea2013-03-08 13:45:27 +00004042- CONFIG_SYS_GENERIC_BOARD
4043 This selects the architecture-generic board system instead of the
4044 architecture-specific board files. It is intended to move boards
4045 to this new framework over time. Defining this will disable the
4046 arch/foo/lib/board.c file and use common/board_f.c and
4047 common/board_r.c instead. To use this option your architecture
4048 must support it (i.e. must define __HAVE_ARCH_GENERIC_BOARD in
4049 its config.mk file). If you find problems enabling this option on
4050 your board please report the problem and send patches!
4051
Lokesh Vutla0b1b60c2013-04-17 20:49:40 +00004052- CONFIG_OMAP_PLATFORM_RESET_TIME_MAX_USEC (OMAP only)
4053 This is set by OMAP boards for the max time that reset should
4054 be asserted. See doc/README.omap-reset-time for details on how
4055 the value can be calulated on a given board.
Simon Glass632efa72013-03-11 07:06:48 +00004056
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004057The following definitions that deal with the placement and management
4058of environment data (variable area); in general, we support the
4059following configurations:
4060
Mike Frysingerc3eb3fe2011-07-08 10:44:25 +00004061- CONFIG_BUILD_ENVCRC:
4062
4063 Builds up envcrc with the target environment so that external utils
4064 may easily extract it and embed it in final U-Boot images.
4065
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD5a1aceb2008-09-10 22:48:04 +02004066- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FLASH:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004067
4068 Define this if the environment is in flash memory.
4069
4070 a) The environment occupies one whole flash sector, which is
4071 "embedded" in the text segment with the U-Boot code. This
4072 happens usually with "bottom boot sector" or "top boot
4073 sector" type flash chips, which have several smaller
4074 sectors at the start or the end. For instance, such a
4075 layout can have sector sizes of 8, 2x4, 16, Nx32 kB. In
4076 such a case you would place the environment in one of the
4077 4 kB sectors - with U-Boot code before and after it. With
4078 "top boot sector" type flash chips, you would put the
4079 environment in one of the last sectors, leaving a gap
4080 between U-Boot and the environment.
4081
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004082 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004083
4084 Offset of environment data (variable area) to the
4085 beginning of flash memory; for instance, with bottom boot
4086 type flash chips the second sector can be used: the offset
4087 for this sector is given here.
4088
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004089 CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET is used relative to CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004090
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004091 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004092
4093 This is just another way to specify the start address of
4094 the flash sector containing the environment (instead of
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004095 CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004096
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004097 - CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004098
4099 Size of the sector containing the environment.
4100
4101
4102 b) Sometimes flash chips have few, equal sized, BIG sectors.
4103 In such a case you don't want to spend a whole sector for
4104 the environment.
4105
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004106 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004107
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD5a1aceb2008-09-10 22:48:04 +02004108 If you use this in combination with CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FLASH
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004109 and CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE, you can specify to use only a part
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004110 of this flash sector for the environment. This saves
4111 memory for the RAM copy of the environment.
4112
4113 It may also save flash memory if you decide to use this
4114 when your environment is "embedded" within U-Boot code,
4115 since then the remainder of the flash sector could be used
4116 for U-Boot code. It should be pointed out that this is
4117 STRONGLY DISCOURAGED from a robustness point of view:
4118 updating the environment in flash makes it always
4119 necessary to erase the WHOLE sector. If something goes
4120 wrong before the contents has been restored from a copy in
4121 RAM, your target system will be dead.
4122
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004123 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR_REDUND
4124 CONFIG_ENV_SIZE_REDUND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004125
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004126 These settings describe a second storage area used to hold
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004127 a redundant copy of the environment data, so that there is
wdenk3e386912003-04-05 00:53:31 +00004128 a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure during
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004129 a "saveenv" operation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004130
4131BE CAREFUL! Any changes to the flash layout, and some changes to the
4132source code will make it necessary to adapt <board>/u-boot.lds*
4133accordingly!
4134
4135
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD9314cee2008-09-10 22:47:59 +02004136- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_NVRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004137
4138 Define this if you have some non-volatile memory device
4139 (NVRAM, battery buffered SRAM) which you want to use for the
4140 environment.
4141
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004142 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
4143 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004144
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004145 These two #defines are used to determine the memory area you
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004146 want to use for environment. It is assumed that this memory
4147 can just be read and written to, without any special
4148 provision.
4149
4150BE CAREFUL! The first access to the environment happens quite early
4151in U-Boot initalization (when we try to get the setting of for the
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004152console baudrate). You *MUST* have mapped your NVRAM area then, or
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004153U-Boot will hang.
4154
4155Please note that even with NVRAM we still use a copy of the
4156environment in RAM: we could work on NVRAM directly, but we want to
4157keep settings there always unmodified except somebody uses "saveenv"
4158to save the current settings.
4159
4160
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDbb1f8b42008-09-05 09:19:30 +02004161- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_EEPROM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004162
4163 Use this if you have an EEPROM or similar serial access
4164 device and a driver for it.
4165
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004166 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
4167 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004168
4169 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the
4170 environment area within the total memory of your EEPROM.
4171
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004172 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004173 If defined, specified the chip address of the EEPROM device.
4174 The default address is zero.
4175
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004176 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_BITS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004177 If defined, the number of bits used to address bytes in a
4178 single page in the EEPROM device. A 64 byte page, for example
4179 would require six bits.
4180
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004181 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_DELAY_MS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004182 If defined, the number of milliseconds to delay between
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00004183 page writes. The default is zero milliseconds.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004184
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004185 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004186 The length in bytes of the EEPROM memory array address. Note
4187 that this is NOT the chip address length!
4188
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004189 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR_OVERFLOW:
wdenk5cf91d62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00004190 EEPROM chips that implement "address overflow" are ones
4191 like Catalyst 24WC04/08/16 which has 9/10/11 bits of
4192 address and the extra bits end up in the "chip address" bit
4193 slots. This makes a 24WC08 (1Kbyte) chip look like four 256
4194 byte chips.
4195
4196 Note that we consider the length of the address field to
4197 still be one byte because the extra address bits are hidden
4198 in the chip address.
4199
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004200 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004201 The size in bytes of the EEPROM device.
4202
Heiko Schocher548738b2010-01-07 08:55:40 +01004203 - CONFIG_ENV_EEPROM_IS_ON_I2C
4204 define this, if you have I2C and SPI activated, and your
4205 EEPROM, which holds the environment, is on the I2C bus.
4206
4207 - CONFIG_I2C_ENV_EEPROM_BUS
4208 if you have an Environment on an EEPROM reached over
4209 I2C muxes, you can define here, how to reach this
4210 EEPROM. For example:
4211
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01004212 #define CONFIG_I2C_ENV_EEPROM_BUS 1
Heiko Schocher548738b2010-01-07 08:55:40 +01004213
4214 EEPROM which holds the environment, is reached over
4215 a pca9547 i2c mux with address 0x70, channel 3.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004216
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD057c8492008-09-10 22:47:58 +02004217- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_DATAFLASH:
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00004218
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00004219 Define this if you have a DataFlash memory device which you
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00004220 want to use for the environment.
4221
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004222 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
4223 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
4224 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00004225
4226 These three #defines specify the offset and size of the
4227 environment area within the total memory of your DataFlash placed
4228 at the specified address.
4229
Wu, Joshbd83b592014-07-01 19:30:13 +08004230- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_SPI_FLASH:
4231
4232 Define this if you have a SPI Flash memory device which you
4233 want to use for the environment.
4234
4235 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
4236 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
4237
4238 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the
4239 environment area within the SPI Flash. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET must be
4240 aligned to an erase sector boundary.
4241
4242 - CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE:
4243
4244 Define the SPI flash's sector size.
4245
4246 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND (optional):
4247
4248 This setting describes a second storage area of CONFIG_ENV_SIZE
4249 size used to hold a redundant copy of the environment data, so
4250 that there is a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure
4251 during a "saveenv" operation. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_RENDUND must be
4252 aligned to an erase sector boundary.
4253
4254 - CONFIG_ENV_SPI_BUS (optional):
4255 - CONFIG_ENV_SPI_CS (optional):
4256
4257 Define the SPI bus and chip select. If not defined they will be 0.
4258
4259 - CONFIG_ENV_SPI_MAX_HZ (optional):
4260
4261 Define the SPI max work clock. If not defined then use 1MHz.
4262
4263 - CONFIG_ENV_SPI_MODE (optional):
4264
4265 Define the SPI work mode. If not defined then use SPI_MODE_3.
4266
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00004267- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_REMOTE:
4268
4269 Define this if you have a remote memory space which you
4270 want to use for the local device's environment.
4271
4272 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
4273 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
4274
4275 These two #defines specify the address and size of the
4276 environment area within the remote memory space. The
4277 local device can get the environment from remote memory
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00004278 space by SRIO or PCIE links.
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00004279
4280BE CAREFUL! For some special cases, the local device can not use
4281"saveenv" command. For example, the local device will get the
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00004282environment stored in a remote NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE link,
4283but it can not erase, write this NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE interface.
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00004284
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD51bfee12008-09-10 22:47:58 +02004285- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_NAND:
wdenk13a56952004-06-09 14:58:14 +00004286
4287 Define this if you have a NAND device which you want to use
4288 for the environment.
4289
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004290 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
4291 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenk13a56952004-06-09 14:58:14 +00004292
4293 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the environment
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05004294 area within the first NAND device. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET must be
4295 aligned to an erase block boundary.
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00004296
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05004297 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND (optional):
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01004298
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004299 This setting describes a second storage area of CONFIG_ENV_SIZE
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05004300 size used to hold a redundant copy of the environment data, so
4301 that there is a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004302 during a "saveenv" operation. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_RENDUND must be
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05004303 aligned to an erase block boundary.
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01004304
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05004305 - CONFIG_ENV_RANGE (optional):
4306
4307 Specifies the length of the region in which the environment
4308 can be written. This should be a multiple of the NAND device's
4309 block size. Specifying a range with more erase blocks than
4310 are needed to hold CONFIG_ENV_SIZE allows bad blocks within
4311 the range to be avoided.
4312
4313 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_OOB (optional):
4314
4315 Enables support for dynamically retrieving the offset of the
4316 environment from block zero's out-of-band data. The
4317 "nand env.oob" command can be used to record this offset.
4318 Currently, CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND is not supported when
4319 using CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_OOB.
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01004320
Guennadi Liakhovetskib74ab732009-05-18 16:07:22 +02004321- CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST
4322
4323 Defines address in RAM to which the nand_spl code should copy the
4324 environment. If redundant environment is used, it will be copied to
4325 CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST + CONFIG_ENV_SIZE.
4326
Joe Hershberger2b744332013-04-08 10:32:51 +00004327- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_UBI:
4328
4329 Define this if you have an UBI volume that you want to use for the
4330 environment. This has the benefit of wear-leveling the environment
4331 accesses, which is important on NAND.
4332
4333 - CONFIG_ENV_UBI_PART:
4334
4335 Define this to a string that is the mtd partition containing the UBI.
4336
4337 - CONFIG_ENV_UBI_VOLUME:
4338
4339 Define this to the name of the volume that you want to store the
4340 environment in.
4341
Joe Hershberger785881f2013-04-08 10:32:52 +00004342 - CONFIG_ENV_UBI_VOLUME_REDUND:
4343
4344 Define this to the name of another volume to store a second copy of
4345 the environment in. This will enable redundant environments in UBI.
4346 It is assumed that both volumes are in the same MTD partition.
4347
Joe Hershberger2b744332013-04-08 10:32:51 +00004348 - CONFIG_UBI_SILENCE_MSG
4349 - CONFIG_UBIFS_SILENCE_MSG
4350
4351 You will probably want to define these to avoid a really noisy system
4352 when storing the env in UBI.
4353
Wu, Joshd1db76f2014-06-24 17:31:03 +08004354- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FAT:
4355 Define this if you want to use the FAT file system for the environment.
4356
4357 - FAT_ENV_INTERFACE:
4358
4359 Define this to a string that is the name of the block device.
4360
4361 - FAT_ENV_DEV_AND_PART:
4362
4363 Define this to a string to specify the partition of the device. It can
4364 be as following:
4365
4366 "D:P", "D:0", "D", "D:" or "D:auto" (D, P are integers. And P >= 1)
4367 - "D:P": device D partition P. Error occurs if device D has no
4368 partition table.
4369 - "D:0": device D.
4370 - "D" or "D:": device D partition 1 if device D has partition
4371 table, or the whole device D if has no partition
4372 table.
4373 - "D:auto": first partition in device D with bootable flag set.
4374 If none, first valid paratition in device D. If no
4375 partition table then means device D.
4376
4377 - FAT_ENV_FILE:
4378
4379 It's a string of the FAT file name. This file use to store the
4380 envrionment.
4381
4382 - CONFIG_FAT_WRITE:
4383 This should be defined. Otherwise it cannot save the envrionment file.
4384
Stephen Warren06e4ae52013-06-11 15:14:00 -06004385- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_MMC:
4386
4387 Define this if you have an MMC device which you want to use for the
4388 environment.
4389
4390 - CONFIG_SYS_MMC_ENV_DEV:
4391
4392 Specifies which MMC device the environment is stored in.
4393
4394 - CONFIG_SYS_MMC_ENV_PART (optional):
4395
4396 Specifies which MMC partition the environment is stored in. If not
4397 set, defaults to partition 0, the user area. Common values might be
4398 1 (first MMC boot partition), 2 (second MMC boot partition).
4399
4400 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
4401 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
4402
4403 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the environment
4404 area within the specified MMC device.
4405
Stephen Warren5c088ee2013-06-11 15:14:02 -06004406 If offset is positive (the usual case), it is treated as relative to
4407 the start of the MMC partition. If offset is negative, it is treated
4408 as relative to the end of the MMC partition. This can be useful if
4409 your board may be fitted with different MMC devices, which have
4410 different sizes for the MMC partitions, and you always want the
4411 environment placed at the very end of the partition, to leave the
4412 maximum possible space before it, to store other data.
4413
Stephen Warren06e4ae52013-06-11 15:14:00 -06004414 These two values are in units of bytes, but must be aligned to an
4415 MMC sector boundary.
4416
4417 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND (optional):
4418
4419 Specifies a second storage area, of CONFIG_ENV_SIZE size, used to
4420 hold a redundant copy of the environment data. This provides a
4421 valid backup copy in case the other copy is corrupted, e.g. due
4422 to a power failure during a "saveenv" operation.
4423
Stephen Warren5c088ee2013-06-11 15:14:02 -06004424 This value may also be positive or negative; this is handled in the
4425 same way as CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET.
4426
Stephen Warren06e4ae52013-06-11 15:14:00 -06004427 This value is also in units of bytes, but must also be aligned to
4428 an MMC sector boundary.
4429
4430 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE_REDUND (optional):
4431
4432 This value need not be set, even when CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND is
4433 set. If this value is set, it must be set to the same value as
4434 CONFIG_ENV_SIZE.
4435
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004436- CONFIG_SYS_SPI_INIT_OFFSET
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004437
4438 Defines offset to the initial SPI buffer area in DPRAM. The
4439 area is used at an early stage (ROM part) if the environment
4440 is configured to reside in the SPI EEPROM: We need a 520 byte
4441 scratch DPRAM area. It is used between the two initialization
4442 calls (spi_init_f() and spi_init_r()). A value of 0xB00 seems
4443 to be a good choice since it makes it far enough from the
4444 start of the data area as well as from the stack pointer.
4445
Bruce Adlere881cb52007-11-02 13:15:42 -07004446Please note that the environment is read-only until the monitor
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004447has been relocated to RAM and a RAM copy of the environment has been
Wolfgang Denkcdb74972010-07-24 21:55:43 +02004448created; also, when using EEPROM you will have to use getenv_f()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004449until then to read environment variables.
4450
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00004451The environment is protected by a CRC32 checksum. Before the monitor
4452is relocated into RAM, as a result of a bad CRC you will be working
4453with the compiled-in default environment - *silently*!!! [This is
4454necessary, because the first environment variable we need is the
4455"baudrate" setting for the console - if we have a bad CRC, we don't
4456have any device yet where we could complain.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004457
4458Note: once the monitor has been relocated, then it will complain if
4459the default environment is used; a new CRC is computed as soon as you
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00004460use the "saveenv" command to store a valid environment.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004461
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004462- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_ECHO_LINK_DOWN:
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00004463 Echo the inverted Ethernet link state to the fault LED.
wdenkfc3e2162003-10-08 22:33:00 +00004464
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004465 Note: If this option is active, then CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR
wdenkfc3e2162003-10-08 22:33:00 +00004466 also needs to be defined.
4467
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004468- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR:
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00004469 MII address of the PHY to check for the Ethernet link state.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004470
Ron Madridf5675aa2009-02-18 14:30:44 -08004471- CONFIG_NS16550_MIN_FUNCTIONS:
4472 Define this if you desire to only have use of the NS16550_init
4473 and NS16550_putc functions for the serial driver located at
4474 drivers/serial/ns16550.c. This option is useful for saving
4475 space for already greatly restricted images, including but not
4476 limited to NAND_SPL configurations.
4477
Simon Glassb2b92f52012-11-30 13:01:18 +00004478- CONFIG_DISPLAY_BOARDINFO
4479 Display information about the board that U-Boot is running on
4480 when U-Boot starts up. The board function checkboard() is called
4481 to do this.
4482
Simon Glasse2e3e2b2012-11-30 13:01:19 +00004483- CONFIG_DISPLAY_BOARDINFO_LATE
4484 Similar to the previous option, but display this information
4485 later, once stdio is running and output goes to the LCD, if
4486 present.
4487
Sascha Silbefeb85802013-08-11 16:40:43 +02004488- CONFIG_BOARD_SIZE_LIMIT:
4489 Maximum size of the U-Boot image. When defined, the
4490 build system checks that the actual size does not
4491 exceed it.
4492
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004493Low Level (hardware related) configuration options:
wdenkdc7c9a12003-03-26 06:55:25 +00004494---------------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004495
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004496- CONFIG_SYS_CACHELINE_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004497 Cache Line Size of the CPU.
4498
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004499- CONFIG_SYS_DEFAULT_IMMR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004500 Default address of the IMMR after system reset.
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00004501
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00004502 Needed on some 8260 systems (MPC8260ADS, PQ2FADS-ZU,
4503 and RPXsuper) to be able to adjust the position of
4504 the IMMR register after a reset.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004505
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05004506- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT:
4507 Default (power-on reset) physical address of CCSR on Freescale
4508 PowerPC SOCs.
4509
4510- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR:
4511 Virtual address of CCSR. On a 32-bit build, this is typically
4512 the same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT.
4513
4514 CONFIG_SYS_DEFAULT_IMMR must also be set to this value,
4515 for cross-platform code that uses that macro instead.
4516
4517- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS:
4518 Physical address of CCSR. CCSR can be relocated to a new
4519 physical address, if desired. In this case, this macro should
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004520 be set to that address. Otherwise, it should be set to the
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05004521 same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT. For example, CCSR
4522 is typically relocated on 36-bit builds. It is recommended
4523 that this macro be defined via the _HIGH and _LOW macros:
4524
4525 #define CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS ((CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH
4526 * 1ull) << 32 | CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW)
4527
4528- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH:
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02004529 Bits 33-36 of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This value is typically
4530 either 0 (32-bit build) or 0xF (36-bit build). This macro is
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05004531 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
4532 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
4533
4534- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW:
4535 Lower 32-bits of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This macro is
4536 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
4537 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
4538
4539- CONFIG_SYS_CCSR_DO_NOT_RELOCATE:
4540 If this macro is defined, then CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS will be
4541 forced to a value that ensures that CCSR is not relocated.
4542
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004543- Floppy Disk Support:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004544 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004545
4546 the default drive number (default value 0)
4547
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004548 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004549
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004550 defines the spacing between FDC chipset registers
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004551 (default value 1)
4552
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004553 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004554
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004555 defines the offset of register from address. It
4556 depends on which part of the data bus is connected to
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004557 the FDC chipset. (default value 0)
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004558
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004559 If CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET and
4560 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER are undefined, they take their
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004561 default value.
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004562
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004563 if CONFIG_SYS_FDC_HW_INIT is defined, then the function
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004564 fdc_hw_init() is called at the beginning of the FDC
4565 setup. fdc_hw_init() must be provided by the board
4566 source code. It is used to make hardware dependant
4567 initializations.
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004568
Macpaul Lin0abddf82011-04-11 20:45:32 +00004569- CONFIG_IDE_AHB:
4570 Most IDE controllers were designed to be connected with PCI
4571 interface. Only few of them were designed for AHB interface.
4572 When software is doing ATA command and data transfer to
4573 IDE devices through IDE-AHB controller, some additional
4574 registers accessing to these kind of IDE-AHB controller
4575 is requierd.
4576
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004577- CONFIG_SYS_IMMR: Physical address of the Internal Memory.
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00004578 DO NOT CHANGE unless you know exactly what you're
wdenk25d67122004-12-10 11:40:40 +00004579 doing! (11-4) [MPC8xx/82xx systems only]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004580
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004581- CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004582
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00004583 Start address of memory area that can be used for
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004584 initial data and stack; please note that this must be
4585 writable memory that is working WITHOUT special
4586 initialization, i. e. you CANNOT use normal RAM which
4587 will become available only after programming the
4588 memory controller and running certain initialization
4589 sequences.
4590
4591 U-Boot uses the following memory types:
4592 - MPC8xx and MPC8260: IMMR (internal memory of the CPU)
4593 - MPC824X: data cache
4594 - PPC4xx: data cache
4595
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004596- CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004597
4598 Offset of the initial data structure in the memory
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004599 area defined by CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR. Usually
4600 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET is chosen such that the initial
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004601 data is located at the end of the available space
Wolfgang Denk553f0982010-10-26 13:32:32 +02004602 (sometimes written as (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_SIZE -
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004603 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_DATA_SIZE), and the initial stack is just
4604 below that area (growing from (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR +
4605 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET) downward.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004606
4607 Note:
4608 On the MPC824X (or other systems that use the data
4609 cache for initial memory) the address chosen for
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004610 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR is basically arbitrary - it must
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004611 point to an otherwise UNUSED address space between
4612 the top of RAM and the start of the PCI space.
4613
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004614- CONFIG_SYS_SIUMCR: SIU Module Configuration (11-6)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004615
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004616- CONFIG_SYS_SYPCR: System Protection Control (11-9)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004617
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004618- CONFIG_SYS_TBSCR: Time Base Status and Control (11-26)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004619
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004620- CONFIG_SYS_PISCR: Periodic Interrupt Status and Control (11-31)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004621
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004622- CONFIG_SYS_PLPRCR: PLL, Low-Power, and Reset Control Register (15-30)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004623
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004624- CONFIG_SYS_SCCR: System Clock and reset Control Register (15-27)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004625
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004626- CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004627 SDRAM timing
4628
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004629- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004630 periodic timer for refresh
4631
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004632- CONFIG_SYS_DER: Debug Event Register (37-47)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004633
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004634- FLASH_BASE0_PRELIM, FLASH_BASE1_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_REMAP_OR_AM,
4635 CONFIG_SYS_PRELIM_OR_AM, CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_FLASH, CONFIG_SYS_OR0_REMAP,
4636 CONFIG_SYS_OR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_REMAP, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_PRELIM,
4637 CONFIG_SYS_BR1_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004638 Memory Controller Definitions: BR0/1 and OR0/1 (FLASH)
4639
4640- SDRAM_BASE2_PRELIM, SDRAM_BASE3_PRELIM, SDRAM_MAX_SIZE,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004641 CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM, CONFIG_SYS_OR2_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR2_PRELIM,
4642 CONFIG_SYS_OR3_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR3_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004643 Memory Controller Definitions: BR2/3 and OR2/3 (SDRAM)
4644
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004645- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_2BK_4K, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_1BK_4K, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_2BK_8K,
4646 CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_1BK_8K, CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_8COL, CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_9COL:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004647 Machine Mode Register and Memory Periodic Timer
4648 Prescaler definitions (SDRAM timing)
4649
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004650- CONFIG_SYS_I2C_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004651 enable I2C microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
4652 define relocation offset in DPRAM [DSP2]
4653
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004654- CONFIG_SYS_SMC_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_SMC_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
Heiko Schocherb423d052008-01-11 01:12:07 +01004655 enable SMC microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
4656 define relocation offset in DPRAM [SMC1]
4657
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004658- CONFIG_SYS_SPI_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_SPI_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004659 enable SPI microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
4660 define relocation offset in DPRAM [SCC4]
4661
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004662- CONFIG_SYS_USE_OSCCLK:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004663 Use OSCM clock mode on MBX8xx board. Be careful,
4664 wrong setting might damage your board. Read
4665 doc/README.MBX before setting this variable!
4666
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004667- CONFIG_SYS_CPM_POST_WORD_ADDR: (MPC8xx, MPC8260 only)
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004668 Offset of the bootmode word in DPRAM used by post
4669 (Power On Self Tests). This definition overrides
4670 #define'd default value in commproc.h resp.
4671 cpm_8260.h.
wdenkea909b72002-11-21 23:11:29 +00004672
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004673- CONFIG_SYS_PCI_SLV_MEM_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_SLV_MEM_BUS, CONFIG_SYS_PICMR0_MASK_ATTRIB,
4674 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR0_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCIMSK0_MASK, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR1_LOCAL,
4675 CONFIG_SYS_PCIMSK1_MASK, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_BUS,
4676 CONFIG_SYS_CPU_PCI_MEM_START, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_POCMR0_MASK_ATTRIB,
4677 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_BUS, CPU_PCI_MEMIO_START,
4678 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_POCMR1_MASK_ATTRIB, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_LOCAL,
4679 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_BUS, CONFIG_SYS_CPU_PCI_IO_START, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_SIZE,
4680 CONFIG_SYS_POCMR2_MASK_ATTRIB: (MPC826x only)
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004681 Overrides the default PCI memory map in arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc8260/pci.c if set.
wdenk5d232d02003-05-22 22:52:13 +00004682
Dirk Eibach9cacf4f2009-02-09 08:18:34 +01004683- CONFIG_PCI_DISABLE_PCIE:
4684 Disable PCI-Express on systems where it is supported but not
4685 required.
4686
Andrew Sharp69fd2d32012-08-29 14:16:32 +00004687- CONFIG_PCI_ENUM_ONLY
4688 Only scan through and get the devices on the busses.
4689 Don't do any setup work, presumably because someone or
4690 something has already done it, and we don't need to do it
4691 a second time. Useful for platforms that are pre-booted
4692 by coreboot or similar.
4693
Gabor Juhos842033e2013-05-30 07:06:12 +00004694- CONFIG_PCI_INDIRECT_BRIDGE:
4695 Enable support for indirect PCI bridges.
4696
Kumar Galaa09b9b62010-12-30 12:09:53 -06004697- CONFIG_SYS_SRIO:
4698 Chip has SRIO or not
4699
4700- CONFIG_SRIO1:
4701 Board has SRIO 1 port available
4702
4703- CONFIG_SRIO2:
4704 Board has SRIO 2 port available
4705
Liu Gangc8b28152013-05-07 16:30:46 +08004706- CONFIG_SRIO_PCIE_BOOT_MASTER
4707 Board can support master function for Boot from SRIO and PCIE
4708
Kumar Galaa09b9b62010-12-30 12:09:53 -06004709- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_VIRT:
4710 Virtual Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
4711
4712- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_PHYS:
4713 Physical Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
4714
4715- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_SIZE:
4716 Size of SRIO port 'n' memory region
4717
Fabio Estevam66bd1842013-04-11 09:35:34 +00004718- CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BUSWIDTH_16BIT
4719 Defined to tell the NAND controller that the NAND chip is using
4720 a 16 bit bus.
4721 Not all NAND drivers use this symbol.
Fabio Estevama430e912013-04-11 09:35:35 +00004722 Example of drivers that use it:
Fabio Estevam66bd1842013-04-11 09:35:34 +00004723 - drivers/mtd/nand/ndfc.c
Fabio Estevama430e912013-04-11 09:35:35 +00004724 - drivers/mtd/nand/mxc_nand.c
Alex Watermaneced4622011-05-19 15:08:36 -04004725
4726- CONFIG_SYS_NDFC_EBC0_CFG
4727 Sets the EBC0_CFG register for the NDFC. If not defined
4728 a default value will be used.
4729
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04004730- CONFIG_SPD_EEPROM
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004731 Get DDR timing information from an I2C EEPROM. Common
4732 with pluggable memory modules such as SODIMMs
4733
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04004734 SPD_EEPROM_ADDRESS
4735 I2C address of the SPD EEPROM
4736
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004737- CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004738 If SPD EEPROM is on an I2C bus other than the first
4739 one, specify here. Note that the value must resolve
4740 to something your driver can deal with.
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04004741
York Sun1b3e3c42011-06-07 09:42:16 +08004742- CONFIG_SYS_DDR_RAW_TIMING
4743 Get DDR timing information from other than SPD. Common with
4744 soldered DDR chips onboard without SPD. DDR raw timing
4745 parameters are extracted from datasheet and hard-coded into
4746 header files or board specific files.
4747
York Sun6f5e1dc2011-09-16 13:21:35 -07004748- CONFIG_FSL_DDR_INTERACTIVE
4749 Enable interactive DDR debugging. See doc/README.fsl-ddr.
4750
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004751- CONFIG_SYS_83XX_DDR_USES_CS0
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004752 Only for 83xx systems. If specified, then DDR should
4753 be configured using CS0 and CS1 instead of CS2 and CS3.
Timur Tabi2ad6b512006-10-31 18:44:42 -06004754
wdenkc26e4542004-04-18 10:13:26 +00004755- CONFIG_ETHER_ON_FEC[12]
4756 Define to enable FEC[12] on a 8xx series processor.
4757
4758- CONFIG_FEC[12]_PHY
4759 Define to the hardcoded PHY address which corresponds
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00004760 to the given FEC; i. e.
4761 #define CONFIG_FEC1_PHY 4
wdenkc26e4542004-04-18 10:13:26 +00004762 means that the PHY with address 4 is connected to FEC1
4763
4764 When set to -1, means to probe for first available.
4765
4766- CONFIG_FEC[12]_PHY_NORXERR
4767 The PHY does not have a RXERR line (RMII only).
4768 (so program the FEC to ignore it).
4769
4770- CONFIG_RMII
4771 Enable RMII mode for all FECs.
4772 Note that this is a global option, we can't
4773 have one FEC in standard MII mode and another in RMII mode.
4774
wdenk5cf91d62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00004775- CONFIG_CRC32_VERIFY
4776 Add a verify option to the crc32 command.
4777 The syntax is:
4778
4779 => crc32 -v <address> <count> <crc32>
4780
4781 Where address/count indicate a memory area
4782 and crc32 is the correct crc32 which the
4783 area should have.
4784
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00004785- CONFIG_LOOPW
4786 Add the "loopw" memory command. This only takes effect if
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05004787 the memory commands are activated globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEM).
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00004788
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00004789- CONFIG_MX_CYCLIC
4790 Add the "mdc" and "mwc" memory commands. These are cyclic
4791 "md/mw" commands.
4792 Examples:
4793
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00004794 => mdc.b 10 4 500
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00004795 This command will print 4 bytes (10,11,12,13) each 500 ms.
4796
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00004797 => mwc.l 100 12345678 10
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00004798 This command will write 12345678 to address 100 all 10 ms.
4799
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00004800 This only takes effect if the memory commands are activated
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05004801 globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEM).
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00004802
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00004803- CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00004804 [ARM, NDS32, MIPS only] If this variable is defined, then certain
Wolfgang Denk844f07d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01004805 low level initializations (like setting up the memory
4806 controller) are omitted and/or U-Boot does not
4807 relocate itself into RAM.
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00004808
Wolfgang Denk844f07d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01004809 Normally this variable MUST NOT be defined. The only
4810 exception is when U-Boot is loaded (to RAM) by some
4811 other boot loader or by a debugger which performs
4812 these initializations itself.
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00004813
Aneesh V401bb302011-07-13 05:11:07 +00004814- CONFIG_SPL_BUILD
Magnus Liljadf812382009-06-13 20:50:00 +02004815 Modifies the behaviour of start.S when compiling a loader
4816 that is executed before the actual U-Boot. E.g. when
4817 compiling a NAND SPL.
wdenk400558b2005-04-02 23:52:25 +00004818
Ying Zhang3aa29de2013-08-16 15:16:15 +08004819- CONFIG_TPL_BUILD
4820 Modifies the behaviour of start.S when compiling a loader
4821 that is executed after the SPL and before the actual U-Boot.
4822 It is loaded by the SPL.
4823
Ying Zhang5df572f2013-05-20 14:07:23 +08004824- CONFIG_SYS_MPC85XX_NO_RESETVEC
4825 Only for 85xx systems. If this variable is specified, the section
4826 .resetvec is not kept and the section .bootpg is placed in the
4827 previous 4k of the .text section.
4828
Simon Glass4213fc22013-02-24 17:33:14 +00004829- CONFIG_ARCH_MAP_SYSMEM
4830 Generally U-Boot (and in particular the md command) uses
4831 effective address. It is therefore not necessary to regard
4832 U-Boot address as virtual addresses that need to be translated
4833 to physical addresses. However, sandbox requires this, since
4834 it maintains its own little RAM buffer which contains all
4835 addressable memory. This option causes some memory accesses
4836 to be mapped through map_sysmem() / unmap_sysmem().
4837
Matthias Weisserd8834a12011-03-10 21:36:32 +00004838- CONFIG_USE_ARCH_MEMCPY
4839 CONFIG_USE_ARCH_MEMSET
4840 If these options are used a optimized version of memcpy/memset will
4841 be used if available. These functions may be faster under some
4842 conditions but may increase the binary size.
4843
Simon Glass588a13f2013-02-14 04:18:54 +00004844- CONFIG_X86_RESET_VECTOR
4845 If defined, the x86 reset vector code is included. This is not
4846 needed when U-Boot is running from Coreboot.
Gabe Blackb16f5212012-11-27 21:08:06 +00004847
Mark Jacksonfc337052013-03-04 01:27:20 +00004848- CONFIG_SYS_MPUCLK
4849 Defines the MPU clock speed (in MHz).
4850
4851 NOTE : currently only supported on AM335x platforms.
Gabe Black5b5ece92012-11-29 16:23:41 +00004852
Heiko Schocher16678eb2013-11-04 14:05:00 +01004853- CONFIG_SPL_AM33XX_ENABLE_RTC32K_OSC:
4854 Enables the RTC32K OSC on AM33xx based plattforms
4855
Karicheri, Muralidharan999d7d32014-04-04 13:16:50 -04004856- CONFIG_SYS_NAND_NO_SUBPAGE_WRITE
4857 Option to disable subpage write in NAND driver
4858 driver that uses this:
4859 drivers/mtd/nand/davinci_nand.c
4860
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06004861Freescale QE/FMAN Firmware Support:
4862-----------------------------------
4863
4864The Freescale QUICCEngine (QE) and Frame Manager (FMAN) both support the
4865loading of "firmware", which is encoded in the QE firmware binary format.
4866This firmware often needs to be loaded during U-Boot booting, so macros
4867are used to identify the storage device (NOR flash, SPI, etc) and the address
4868within that device.
4869
Zhao Qiangdcf1d772014-03-21 16:21:44 +08004870- CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR
4871 The address in the storage device where the FMAN microcode is located. The
4872 meaning of this address depends on which CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_IN_xxx macro
4873 is also specified.
4874
4875- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_ADDR
4876 The address in the storage device where the QE microcode is located. The
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06004877 meaning of this address depends on which CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_IN_xxx macro
4878 is also specified.
4879
4880- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_LENGTH
4881 The maximum possible size of the firmware. The firmware binary format
4882 has a field that specifies the actual size of the firmware, but it
4883 might not be possible to read any part of the firmware unless some
4884 local storage is allocated to hold the entire firmware first.
4885
4886- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NOR
4887 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NOR flash, mapped as
4888 normal addressable memory via the LBC. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the
4889 virtual address in NOR flash.
4890
4891- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NAND
4892 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NAND flash.
4893 CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the offset within NAND flash.
4894
4895- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_MMC
4896 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located on the primary SD/MMC
4897 device. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the byte offset on that device.
4898
4899- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_SPIFLASH
4900 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located on the primary SPI
4901 device. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the byte offset on that device.
4902
Liu Gang292dc6c2012-03-08 00:33:18 +00004903- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_REMOTE
4904 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in the remote (master)
4905 memory space. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is a virtual address which
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00004906 can be mapped from slave TLB->slave LAW->slave SRIO or PCIE outbound
4907 window->master inbound window->master LAW->the ucode address in
4908 master's memory space.
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06004909
J. German Riverab940ca62014-06-23 15:15:55 -07004910Freescale Layerscape Management Complex Firmware Support:
4911---------------------------------------------------------
4912The Freescale Layerscape Management Complex (MC) supports the loading of
4913"firmware".
4914This firmware often needs to be loaded during U-Boot booting, so macros
4915are used to identify the storage device (NOR flash, SPI, etc) and the address
4916within that device.
4917
4918- CONFIG_FSL_MC_ENET
4919 Enable the MC driver for Layerscape SoCs.
4920
4921- CONFIG_SYS_LS_MC_FW_ADDR
4922 The address in the storage device where the firmware is located. The
4923 meaning of this address depends on which CONFIG_SYS_LS_MC_FW_IN_xxx macro
4924 is also specified.
4925
4926- CONFIG_SYS_LS_MC_FW_LENGTH
4927 The maximum possible size of the firmware. The firmware binary format
4928 has a field that specifies the actual size of the firmware, but it
4929 might not be possible to read any part of the firmware unless some
4930 local storage is allocated to hold the entire firmware first.
4931
4932- CONFIG_SYS_LS_MC_FW_IN_NOR
4933 Specifies that MC firmware is located in NOR flash, mapped as
4934 normal addressable memory via the LBC. CONFIG_SYS_LS_MC_FW_ADDR is the
4935 virtual address in NOR flash.
4936
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004937Building the Software:
4938======================
4939
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004940Building U-Boot has been tested in several native build environments
4941and in many different cross environments. Of course we cannot support
4942all possibly existing versions of cross development tools in all
4943(potentially obsolete) versions. In case of tool chain problems we
4944recommend to use the ELDK (see http://www.denx.de/wiki/DULG/ELDK)
4945which is extensively used to build and test U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004946
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004947If you are not using a native environment, it is assumed that you
4948have GNU cross compiling tools available in your path. In this case,
4949you must set the environment variable CROSS_COMPILE in your shell.
4950Note that no changes to the Makefile or any other source files are
4951necessary. For example using the ELDK on a 4xx CPU, please enter:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004952
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004953 $ CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_4xx-
4954 $ export CROSS_COMPILE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004955
Peter Tyser2f8d3962009-03-13 18:54:51 -05004956Note: If you wish to generate Windows versions of the utilities in
4957 the tools directory you can use the MinGW toolchain
4958 (http://www.mingw.org). Set your HOST tools to the MinGW
4959 toolchain and execute 'make tools'. For example:
4960
4961 $ make HOSTCC=i586-mingw32msvc-gcc HOSTSTRIP=i586-mingw32msvc-strip tools
4962
4963 Binaries such as tools/mkimage.exe will be created which can
4964 be executed on computers running Windows.
4965
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004966U-Boot is intended to be simple to build. After installing the
4967sources you must configure U-Boot for one specific board type. This
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004968is done by typing:
4969
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02004970 make NAME_defconfig
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004971
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02004972where "NAME_defconfig" is the name of one of the existing configu-
Michael Jones4d675ae2012-03-15 22:48:10 +00004973rations; see boards.cfg for supported names.
wdenk54387ac2003-10-08 22:45:44 +00004974
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004975Note: for some board special configuration names may exist; check if
4976 additional information is available from the board vendor; for
4977 instance, the TQM823L systems are available without (standard)
4978 or with LCD support. You can select such additional "features"
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004979 when choosing the configuration, i. e.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004980
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02004981 make TQM823L_defconfig
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004982 - will configure for a plain TQM823L, i. e. no LCD support
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004983
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02004984 make TQM823L_LCD_defconfig
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004985 - will configure for a TQM823L with U-Boot console on LCD
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004986
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004987 etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004988
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004989
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004990Finally, type "make all", and you should get some working U-Boot
4991images ready for download to / installation on your system:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004992
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004993- "u-boot.bin" is a raw binary image
4994- "u-boot" is an image in ELF binary format
4995- "u-boot.srec" is in Motorola S-Record format
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004996
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02004997By default the build is performed locally and the objects are saved
4998in the source directory. One of the two methods can be used to change
4999this behavior and build U-Boot to some external directory:
5000
50011. Add O= to the make command line invocations:
5002
5003 make O=/tmp/build distclean
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02005004 make O=/tmp/build NAME_defconfig
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005005 make O=/tmp/build all
5006
50072. Set environment variable BUILD_DIR to point to the desired location:
5008
5009 export BUILD_DIR=/tmp/build
5010 make distclean
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02005011 make NAME_defconfig
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005012 make all
5013
5014Note that the command line "O=" setting overrides the BUILD_DIR environment
5015variable.
5016
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005017
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005018Please be aware that the Makefiles assume you are using GNU make, so
5019for instance on NetBSD you might need to use "gmake" instead of
5020native "make".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005021
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005022
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005023If the system board that you have is not listed, then you will need
5024to port U-Boot to your hardware platform. To do this, follow these
5025steps:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005026
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000050271. Add a new configuration option for your board to the toplevel
Michael Jones4d675ae2012-03-15 22:48:10 +00005028 "boards.cfg" file, using the existing entries as examples.
5029 Follow the instructions there to keep the boards in order.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000050302. Create a new directory to hold your board specific code. Add any
5031 files you need. In your board directory, you will need at least
5032 the "Makefile", a "<board>.c", "flash.c" and "u-boot.lds".
50333. Create a new configuration file "include/configs/<board>.h" for
5034 your board
50353. If you're porting U-Boot to a new CPU, then also create a new
5036 directory to hold your CPU specific code. Add any files you need.
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +020050374. Run "make <board>_defconfig" with your new name.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000050385. Type "make", and you should get a working "u-boot.srec" file
5039 to be installed on your target system.
50406. Debug and solve any problems that might arise.
5041 [Of course, this last step is much harder than it sounds.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005042
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005043
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005044Testing of U-Boot Modifications, Ports to New Hardware, etc.:
5045==============================================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005046
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005047If you have modified U-Boot sources (for instance added a new board
5048or support for new devices, a new CPU, etc.) you are expected to
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005049provide feedback to the other developers. The feedback normally takes
5050the form of a "patch", i. e. a context diff against a certain (latest
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005051official or latest in the git repository) version of U-Boot sources.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005052
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005053But before you submit such a patch, please verify that your modifi-
5054cation did not break existing code. At least make sure that *ALL* of
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005055the supported boards compile WITHOUT ANY compiler warnings. To do so,
5056just run the "MAKEALL" script, which will configure and build U-Boot
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005057for ALL supported system. Be warned, this will take a while. You can
5058select which (cross) compiler to use by passing a `CROSS_COMPILE'
5059environment variable to the script, i. e. to use the ELDK cross tools
5060you can type
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005061
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005062 CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_8xx- MAKEALL
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005063
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005064or to build on a native PowerPC system you can type
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005065
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005066 CROSS_COMPILE=' ' MAKEALL
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005067
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005068When using the MAKEALL script, the default behaviour is to build
5069U-Boot in the source directory. This location can be changed by
5070setting the BUILD_DIR environment variable. Also, for each target
5071built, the MAKEALL script saves two log files (<target>.ERR and
5072<target>.MAKEALL) in the <source dir>/LOG directory. This default
5073location can be changed by setting the MAKEALL_LOGDIR environment
5074variable. For example:
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005075
5076 export BUILD_DIR=/tmp/build
5077 export MAKEALL_LOGDIR=/tmp/log
5078 CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_8xx- MAKEALL
5079
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005080With the above settings build objects are saved in the /tmp/build,
5081log files are saved in the /tmp/log and the source tree remains clean
5082during the whole build process.
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005083
5084
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005085See also "U-Boot Porting Guide" below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005086
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005087
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005088Monitor Commands - Overview:
5089============================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005090
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005091go - start application at address 'addr'
5092run - run commands in an environment variable
5093bootm - boot application image from memory
5094bootp - boot image via network using BootP/TFTP protocol
Marek Vasut44f074c2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00005095bootz - boot zImage from memory
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005096tftpboot- boot image via network using TFTP protocol
5097 and env variables "ipaddr" and "serverip"
5098 (and eventually "gatewayip")
Simon Glass1fb7cd42011-10-24 18:00:07 +00005099tftpput - upload a file via network using TFTP protocol
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005100rarpboot- boot image via network using RARP/TFTP protocol
5101diskboot- boot from IDE devicebootd - boot default, i.e., run 'bootcmd'
5102loads - load S-Record file over serial line
5103loadb - load binary file over serial line (kermit mode)
5104md - memory display
5105mm - memory modify (auto-incrementing)
5106nm - memory modify (constant address)
5107mw - memory write (fill)
5108cp - memory copy
5109cmp - memory compare
5110crc32 - checksum calculation
Peter Tyser0f89c542009-04-18 22:34:03 -05005111i2c - I2C sub-system
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005112sspi - SPI utility commands
5113base - print or set address offset
5114printenv- print environment variables
5115setenv - set environment variables
5116saveenv - save environment variables to persistent storage
5117protect - enable or disable FLASH write protection
5118erase - erase FLASH memory
5119flinfo - print FLASH memory information
Karl O. Pinc10635af2012-08-03 05:57:21 +00005120nand - NAND memory operations (see doc/README.nand)
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005121bdinfo - print Board Info structure
5122iminfo - print header information for application image
5123coninfo - print console devices and informations
5124ide - IDE sub-system
5125loop - infinite loop on address range
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00005126loopw - infinite write loop on address range
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005127mtest - simple RAM test
5128icache - enable or disable instruction cache
5129dcache - enable or disable data cache
5130reset - Perform RESET of the CPU
5131echo - echo args to console
5132version - print monitor version
5133help - print online help
5134? - alias for 'help'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005135
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005136
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005137Monitor Commands - Detailed Description:
5138========================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005139
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005140TODO.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005141
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005142For now: just type "help <command>".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005143
5144
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005145Environment Variables:
5146======================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005147
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005148U-Boot supports user configuration using Environment Variables which
5149can be made persistent by saving to Flash memory.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005150
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005151Environment Variables are set using "setenv", printed using
5152"printenv", and saved to Flash using "saveenv". Using "setenv"
5153without a value can be used to delete a variable from the
5154environment. As long as you don't save the environment you are
5155working with an in-memory copy. In case the Flash area containing the
5156environment is erased by accident, a default environment is provided.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005157
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01005158Some configuration options can be set using Environment Variables.
5159
5160List of environment variables (most likely not complete):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005161
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005162 baudrate - see CONFIG_BAUDRATE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005163
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005164 bootdelay - see CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005165
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005166 bootcmd - see CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005167
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005168 bootargs - Boot arguments when booting an RTOS image
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005169
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005170 bootfile - Name of the image to load with TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005171
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02005172 bootm_low - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
5173 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
5174 a hexadecimal number and defines lowest address allowed
5175 for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_size"
5176 environment variable. Address defined by "bootm_low" is
5177 also the base of the initial memory mapping for the Linux
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00005178 kernel -- see the description of CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ and
5179 bootm_mapsize.
5180
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00005181 bootm_mapsize - Size of the initial memory mapping for the Linux kernel.
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00005182 This variable is given as a hexadecimal number and it
5183 defines the size of the memory region starting at base
5184 address bootm_low that is accessible by the Linux kernel
5185 during early boot. If unset, CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is used
5186 as the default value if it is defined, and bootm_size is
5187 used otherwise.
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02005188
5189 bootm_size - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
5190 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
5191 a hexadecimal number and defines the size of the region
5192 allowed for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_low"
5193 environment variable.
5194
Bartlomiej Sieka4bae9092008-10-01 15:26:31 +02005195 updatefile - Location of the software update file on a TFTP server, used
5196 by the automatic software update feature. Please refer to
5197 documentation in doc/README.update for more details.
5198
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005199 autoload - if set to "no" (any string beginning with 'n'),
5200 "bootp" will just load perform a lookup of the
5201 configuration from the BOOTP server, but not try to
5202 load any image using TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005203
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005204 autostart - if set to "yes", an image loaded using the "bootp",
5205 "rarpboot", "tftpboot" or "diskboot" commands will
5206 be automatically started (by internally calling
5207 "bootm")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005208
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005209 If set to "no", a standalone image passed to the
5210 "bootm" command will be copied to the load address
5211 (and eventually uncompressed), but NOT be started.
5212 This can be used to load and uncompress arbitrary
5213 data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005214
David A. Longa28afca2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04005215 fdt_high - if set this restricts the maximum address that the
5216 flattened device tree will be copied into upon boot.
Shawn Guofa34f6b2012-01-09 21:54:08 +00005217 For example, if you have a system with 1 GB memory
5218 at physical address 0x10000000, while Linux kernel
5219 only recognizes the first 704 MB as low memory, you
5220 may need to set fdt_high as 0x3C000000 to have the
5221 device tree blob be copied to the maximum address
5222 of the 704 MB low memory, so that Linux kernel can
5223 access it during the boot procedure.
5224
David A. Longa28afca2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04005225 If this is set to the special value 0xFFFFFFFF then
5226 the fdt will not be copied at all on boot. For this
5227 to work it must reside in writable memory, have
5228 sufficient padding on the end of it for u-boot to
5229 add the information it needs into it, and the memory
5230 must be accessible by the kernel.
5231
Simon Glasseea63e02011-10-24 19:15:34 +00005232 fdtcontroladdr- if set this is the address of the control flattened
5233 device tree used by U-Boot when CONFIG_OF_CONTROL is
5234 defined.
5235
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00005236 i2cfast - (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
5237 if set to 'y' configures Linux I2C driver for fast
5238 mode (400kHZ). This environment variable is used in
5239 initialization code. So, for changes to be effective
5240 it must be saved and board must be reset.
5241
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005242 initrd_high - restrict positioning of initrd images:
5243 If this variable is not set, initrd images will be
5244 copied to the highest possible address in RAM; this
5245 is usually what you want since it allows for
5246 maximum initrd size. If for some reason you want to
5247 make sure that the initrd image is loaded below the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02005248 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ limit, you can set this environment
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005249 variable to a value of "no" or "off" or "0".
5250 Alternatively, you can set it to a maximum upper
5251 address to use (U-Boot will still check that it
5252 does not overwrite the U-Boot stack and data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005253
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005254 For instance, when you have a system with 16 MB
5255 RAM, and want to reserve 4 MB from use by Linux,
5256 you can do this by adding "mem=12M" to the value of
5257 the "bootargs" variable. However, now you must make
5258 sure that the initrd image is placed in the first
5259 12 MB as well - this can be done with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005260
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005261 setenv initrd_high 00c00000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005262
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005263 If you set initrd_high to 0xFFFFFFFF, this is an
5264 indication to U-Boot that all addresses are legal
5265 for the Linux kernel, including addresses in flash
5266 memory. In this case U-Boot will NOT COPY the
5267 ramdisk at all. This may be useful to reduce the
5268 boot time on your system, but requires that this
5269 feature is supported by your Linux kernel.
wdenk4a6fd342003-04-12 23:38:12 +00005270
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005271 ipaddr - IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005272
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005273 loadaddr - Default load address for commands like "bootp",
5274 "rarpboot", "tftpboot", "loadb" or "diskboot"
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005275
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005276 loads_echo - see CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005277
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005278 serverip - TFTP server IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenk38b99262003-05-23 23:18:21 +00005279
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005280 bootretry - see CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005281
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005282 bootdelaykey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005283
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005284 bootstopkey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005285
Mike Frysingere2a53452011-10-02 10:01:27 +00005286 ethprime - controls which interface is used first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005287
Mike Frysingere2a53452011-10-02 10:01:27 +00005288 ethact - controls which interface is currently active.
5289 For example you can do the following
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005290
Heiko Schocher48690d82010-07-20 17:45:02 +02005291 => setenv ethact FEC
5292 => ping 192.168.0.1 # traffic sent on FEC
5293 => setenv ethact SCC
5294 => ping 10.0.0.1 # traffic sent on SCC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005295
Matthias Fuchse1692572008-01-17 07:45:05 +01005296 ethrotate - When set to "no" U-Boot does not go through all
5297 available network interfaces.
5298 It just stays at the currently selected interface.
5299
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01005300 netretry - When set to "no" each network operation will
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005301 either succeed or fail without retrying.
5302 When set to "once" the network operation will
5303 fail when all the available network interfaces
5304 are tried once without success.
5305 Useful on scripts which control the retry operation
5306 themselves.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005307
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDb4e2f892009-01-31 09:53:39 +01005308 npe_ucode - set load address for the NPE microcode
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDa1cf0272008-01-07 08:41:34 +01005309
Simon Glass8d51aac2013-07-16 20:10:00 -07005310 silent_linux - If set then linux will be told to boot silently, by
5311 changing the console to be empty. If "yes" it will be
5312 made silent. If "no" it will not be made silent. If
5313 unset, then it will be made silent if the U-Boot console
5314 is silent.
5315
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02005316 tftpsrcport - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02005317 UDP source port.
5318
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02005319 tftpdstport - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's UDP
5320 destination port instead of the Well Know Port 69.
5321
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01005322 tftpblocksize - Block size to use for TFTP transfers; if not set,
5323 we use the TFTP server's default block size
5324
5325 tftptimeout - Retransmission timeout for TFTP packets (in milli-
5326 seconds, minimum value is 1000 = 1 second). Defines
5327 when a packet is considered to be lost so it has to
5328 be retransmitted. The default is 5000 = 5 seconds.
5329 Lowering this value may make downloads succeed
5330 faster in networks with high packet loss rates or
5331 with unreliable TFTP servers.
5332
5333 vlan - When set to a value < 4095 the traffic over
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005334 Ethernet is encapsulated/received over 802.1q
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005335 VLAN tagged frames.
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00005336
Jason Hobbsdc0b7b02011-08-31 05:37:28 +00005337The following image location variables contain the location of images
5338used in booting. The "Image" column gives the role of the image and is
5339not an environment variable name. The other columns are environment
5340variable names. "File Name" gives the name of the file on a TFTP
5341server, "RAM Address" gives the location in RAM the image will be
5342loaded to, and "Flash Location" gives the image's address in NOR
5343flash or offset in NAND flash.
5344
5345*Note* - these variables don't have to be defined for all boards, some
5346boards currenlty use other variables for these purposes, and some
5347boards use these variables for other purposes.
5348
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00005349Image File Name RAM Address Flash Location
5350----- --------- ----------- --------------
5351u-boot u-boot u-boot_addr_r u-boot_addr
5352Linux kernel bootfile kernel_addr_r kernel_addr
5353device tree blob fdtfile fdt_addr_r fdt_addr
5354ramdisk ramdiskfile ramdisk_addr_r ramdisk_addr
Jason Hobbsdc0b7b02011-08-31 05:37:28 +00005355
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005356The following environment variables may be used and automatically
5357updated by the network boot commands ("bootp" and "rarpboot"),
5358depending the information provided by your boot server:
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00005359
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005360 bootfile - see above
5361 dnsip - IP address of your Domain Name Server
5362 dnsip2 - IP address of your secondary Domain Name Server
5363 gatewayip - IP address of the Gateway (Router) to use
5364 hostname - Target hostname
5365 ipaddr - see above
5366 netmask - Subnet Mask
5367 rootpath - Pathname of the root filesystem on the NFS server
5368 serverip - see above
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00005369
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00005370
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005371There are two special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005372
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005373 serial# - contains hardware identification information such
5374 as type string and/or serial number
5375 ethaddr - Ethernet address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005376
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005377These variables can be set only once (usually during manufacturing of
5378the board). U-Boot refuses to delete or overwrite these variables
5379once they have been set once.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005380
5381
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005382Further special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005383
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005384 ver - Contains the U-Boot version string as printed
5385 with the "version" command. This variable is
5386 readonly (see CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005387
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005388
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005389Please note that changes to some configuration parameters may take
5390only effect after the next boot (yes, that's just like Windoze :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005391
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00005392
Joe Hershberger170ab112012-12-11 22:16:24 -06005393Callback functions for environment variables:
5394---------------------------------------------
5395
5396For some environment variables, the behavior of u-boot needs to change
5397when their values are changed. This functionailty allows functions to
5398be associated with arbitrary variables. On creation, overwrite, or
5399deletion, the callback will provide the opportunity for some side
5400effect to happen or for the change to be rejected.
5401
5402The callbacks are named and associated with a function using the
5403U_BOOT_ENV_CALLBACK macro in your board or driver code.
5404
5405These callbacks are associated with variables in one of two ways. The
5406static list can be added to by defining CONFIG_ENV_CALLBACK_LIST_STATIC
5407in the board configuration to a string that defines a list of
5408associations. The list must be in the following format:
5409
5410 entry = variable_name[:callback_name]
5411 list = entry[,list]
5412
5413If the callback name is not specified, then the callback is deleted.
5414Spaces are also allowed anywhere in the list.
5415
5416Callbacks can also be associated by defining the ".callbacks" variable
5417with the same list format above. Any association in ".callbacks" will
5418override any association in the static list. You can define
5419CONFIG_ENV_CALLBACK_LIST_DEFAULT to a list (string) to define the
5420".callbacks" envirnoment variable in the default or embedded environment.
5421
5422
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005423Command Line Parsing:
5424=====================
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00005425
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005426There are two different command line parsers available with U-Boot:
5427the old "simple" one, and the much more powerful "hush" shell:
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00005428
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005429Old, simple command line parser:
5430--------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005431
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005432- supports environment variables (through setenv / saveenv commands)
5433- several commands on one line, separated by ';'
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01005434- variable substitution using "... ${name} ..." syntax
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005435- special characters ('$', ';') can be escaped by prefixing with '\',
5436 for example:
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01005437 setenv bootcmd bootm \${address}
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005438- You can also escape text by enclosing in single apostrophes, for example:
5439 setenv addip 'setenv bootargs $bootargs ip=$ipaddr:$serverip:$gatewayip:$netmask:$hostname::off'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005440
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005441Hush shell:
5442-----------
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005443
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005444- similar to Bourne shell, with control structures like
5445 if...then...else...fi, for...do...done; while...do...done,
5446 until...do...done, ...
5447- supports environment ("global") variables (through setenv / saveenv
5448 commands) and local shell variables (through standard shell syntax
5449 "name=value"); only environment variables can be used with "run"
5450 command
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005451
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005452General rules:
5453--------------
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005454
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005455(1) If a command line (or an environment variable executed by a "run"
5456 command) contains several commands separated by semicolon, and
5457 one of these commands fails, then the remaining commands will be
5458 executed anyway.
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005459
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005460(2) If you execute several variables with one call to run (i. e.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005461 calling run with a list of variables as arguments), any failing
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005462 command will cause "run" to terminate, i. e. the remaining
5463 variables are not executed.
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005464
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005465Note for Redundant Ethernet Interfaces:
5466=======================================
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005467
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005468Some boards come with redundant Ethernet interfaces; U-Boot supports
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005469such configurations and is capable of automatic selection of a
5470"working" interface when needed. MAC assignment works as follows:
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005471
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005472Network interfaces are numbered eth0, eth1, eth2, ... Corresponding
5473MAC addresses can be stored in the environment as "ethaddr" (=>eth0),
5474"eth1addr" (=>eth1), "eth2addr", ...
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005475
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005476If the network interface stores some valid MAC address (for instance
5477in SROM), this is used as default address if there is NO correspon-
5478ding setting in the environment; if the corresponding environment
5479variable is set, this overrides the settings in the card; that means:
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005480
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005481o If the SROM has a valid MAC address, and there is no address in the
5482 environment, the SROM's address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005483
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005484o If there is no valid address in the SROM, and a definition in the
5485 environment exists, then the value from the environment variable is
5486 used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005487
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005488o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and
5489 both addresses are the same, this MAC address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005490
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005491o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and the
5492 addresses differ, the value from the environment is used and a
5493 warning is printed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005494
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005495o If neither SROM nor the environment contain a MAC address, an error
5496 is raised.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005497
Ben Warrenecee9322010-04-26 11:11:46 -07005498If Ethernet drivers implement the 'write_hwaddr' function, valid MAC addresses
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00005499will be programmed into hardware as part of the initialization process. This
Ben Warrenecee9322010-04-26 11:11:46 -07005500may be skipped by setting the appropriate 'ethmacskip' environment variable.
5501The naming convention is as follows:
5502"ethmacskip" (=>eth0), "eth1macskip" (=>eth1) etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005503
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005504Image Formats:
5505==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005506
Marian Balakowicz3310c542008-03-12 12:13:13 +01005507U-Boot is capable of booting (and performing other auxiliary operations on)
5508images in two formats:
5509
5510New uImage format (FIT)
5511-----------------------
5512
5513Flexible and powerful format based on Flattened Image Tree -- FIT (similar
5514to Flattened Device Tree). It allows the use of images with multiple
5515components (several kernels, ramdisks, etc.), with contents protected by
5516SHA1, MD5 or CRC32. More details are found in the doc/uImage.FIT directory.
5517
5518
5519Old uImage format
5520-----------------
5521
5522Old image format is based on binary files which can be basically anything,
5523preceded by a special header; see the definitions in include/image.h for
5524details; basically, the header defines the following image properties:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005525
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005526* Target Operating System (Provisions for OpenBSD, NetBSD, FreeBSD,
5527 4.4BSD, Linux, SVR4, Esix, Solaris, Irix, SCO, Dell, NCR, VxWorks,
Peter Tyserf5ed9e32008-09-08 14:56:49 -05005528 LynxOS, pSOS, QNX, RTEMS, INTEGRITY;
5529 Currently supported: Linux, NetBSD, VxWorks, QNX, RTEMS, LynxOS,
5530 INTEGRITY).
Wolfgang Denk7b64fef2006-10-24 14:21:16 +02005531* Target CPU Architecture (Provisions for Alpha, ARM, AVR32, Intel x86,
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00005532 IA64, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC, IBM S390, SuperH, Sparc, Sparc 64 Bit;
5533 Currently supported: ARM, AVR32, Intel x86, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC).
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005534* Compression Type (uncompressed, gzip, bzip2)
5535* Load Address
5536* Entry Point
5537* Image Name
5538* Image Timestamp
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005539
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005540The header is marked by a special Magic Number, and both the header
5541and the data portions of the image are secured against corruption by
5542CRC32 checksums.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005543
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005544
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005545Linux Support:
5546==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005547
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005548Although U-Boot should support any OS or standalone application
5549easily, the main focus has always been on Linux during the design of
5550U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005551
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005552U-Boot includes many features that so far have been part of some
5553special "boot loader" code within the Linux kernel. Also, any
5554"initrd" images to be used are no longer part of one big Linux image;
5555instead, kernel and "initrd" are separate images. This implementation
5556serves several purposes:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005557
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005558- the same features can be used for other OS or standalone
5559 applications (for instance: using compressed images to reduce the
5560 Flash memory footprint)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005561
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005562- it becomes much easier to port new Linux kernel versions because
5563 lots of low-level, hardware dependent stuff are done by U-Boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005564
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005565- the same Linux kernel image can now be used with different "initrd"
5566 images; of course this also means that different kernel images can
5567 be run with the same "initrd". This makes testing easier (you don't
5568 have to build a new "zImage.initrd" Linux image when you just
5569 change a file in your "initrd"). Also, a field-upgrade of the
5570 software is easier now.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005571
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005572
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005573Linux HOWTO:
5574============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005575
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005576Porting Linux to U-Boot based systems:
5577---------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005578
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005579U-Boot cannot save you from doing all the necessary modifications to
5580configure the Linux device drivers for use with your target hardware
5581(no, we don't intend to provide a full virtual machine interface to
5582Linux :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005583
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02005584But now you can ignore ALL boot loader code (in arch/powerpc/mbxboot).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005585
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005586Just make sure your machine specific header file (for instance
5587include/asm-ppc/tqm8xx.h) includes the same definition of the Board
Markus Heidelberg1dc30692008-09-07 20:18:27 +02005588Information structure as we define in include/asm-<arch>/u-boot.h,
5589and make sure that your definition of IMAP_ADDR uses the same value
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02005590as your U-Boot configuration in CONFIG_SYS_IMMR.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005591
Simon Glass2eb31b12014-06-11 23:29:46 -06005592Note that U-Boot now has a driver model, a unified model for drivers.
5593If you are adding a new driver, plumb it into driver model. If there
5594is no uclass available, you are encouraged to create one. See
5595doc/driver-model.
5596
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005597
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005598Configuring the Linux kernel:
5599-----------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005600
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005601No specific requirements for U-Boot. Make sure you have some root
5602device (initial ramdisk, NFS) for your target system.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005603
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005604
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005605Building a Linux Image:
5606-----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005607
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005608With U-Boot, "normal" build targets like "zImage" or "bzImage" are
5609not used. If you use recent kernel source, a new build target
5610"uImage" will exist which automatically builds an image usable by
5611U-Boot. Most older kernels also have support for a "pImage" target,
5612which was introduced for our predecessor project PPCBoot and uses a
5613100% compatible format.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005614
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005615Example:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005616
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02005617 make TQM850L_defconfig
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005618 make oldconfig
5619 make dep
5620 make uImage
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005621
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005622The "uImage" build target uses a special tool (in 'tools/mkimage') to
5623encapsulate a compressed Linux kernel image with header information,
5624CRC32 checksum etc. for use with U-Boot. This is what we are doing:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005625
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005626* build a standard "vmlinux" kernel image (in ELF binary format):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005627
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005628* convert the kernel into a raw binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005629
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005630 ${CROSS_COMPILE}-objcopy -O binary \
5631 -R .note -R .comment \
5632 -S vmlinux linux.bin
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005633
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005634* compress the binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005635
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005636 gzip -9 linux.bin
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005637
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005638* package compressed binary image for U-Boot:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005639
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005640 mkimage -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip \
5641 -a 0 -e 0 -n "Linux Kernel Image" \
5642 -d linux.bin.gz uImage
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005643
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005644
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005645The "mkimage" tool can also be used to create ramdisk images for use
5646with U-Boot, either separated from the Linux kernel image, or
5647combined into one file. "mkimage" encapsulates the images with a 64
5648byte header containing information about target architecture,
5649operating system, image type, compression method, entry points, time
5650stamp, CRC32 checksums, etc.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005651
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005652"mkimage" can be called in two ways: to verify existing images and
5653print the header information, or to build new images.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005654
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005655In the first form (with "-l" option) mkimage lists the information
5656contained in the header of an existing U-Boot image; this includes
5657checksum verification:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005658
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005659 tools/mkimage -l image
5660 -l ==> list image header information
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005661
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005662The second form (with "-d" option) is used to build a U-Boot image
5663from a "data file" which is used as image payload:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005664
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005665 tools/mkimage -A arch -O os -T type -C comp -a addr -e ep \
5666 -n name -d data_file image
5667 -A ==> set architecture to 'arch'
5668 -O ==> set operating system to 'os'
5669 -T ==> set image type to 'type'
5670 -C ==> set compression type 'comp'
5671 -a ==> set load address to 'addr' (hex)
5672 -e ==> set entry point to 'ep' (hex)
5673 -n ==> set image name to 'name'
5674 -d ==> use image data from 'datafile'
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005675
wdenk69459792004-05-29 16:53:29 +00005676Right now, all Linux kernels for PowerPC systems use the same load
5677address (0x00000000), but the entry point address depends on the
5678kernel version:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005679
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005680- 2.2.x kernels have the entry point at 0x0000000C,
5681- 2.3.x and later kernels have the entry point at 0x00000000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005682
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005683So a typical call to build a U-Boot image would read:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005684
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005685 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
5686 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02005687 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz \
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005688 > examples/uImage.TQM850L
5689 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
5690 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
5691 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5692 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
5693 Load Address: 0x00000000
5694 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005695
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005696To verify the contents of the image (or check for corruption):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005697
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005698 -> tools/mkimage -l examples/uImage.TQM850L
5699 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
5700 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
5701 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5702 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
5703 Load Address: 0x00000000
5704 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005705
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005706NOTE: for embedded systems where boot time is critical you can trade
5707speed for memory and install an UNCOMPRESSED image instead: this
5708needs more space in Flash, but boots much faster since it does not
5709need to be uncompressed:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005710
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02005711 -> gunzip /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005712 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
5713 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C none -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02005714 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux \
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005715 > examples/uImage.TQM850L-uncompressed
5716 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
5717 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
5718 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (uncompressed)
5719 Data Size: 792160 Bytes = 773.59 kB = 0.76 MB
5720 Load Address: 0x00000000
5721 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005722
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005723
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005724Similar you can build U-Boot images from a 'ramdisk.image.gz' file
5725when your kernel is intended to use an initial ramdisk:
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005726
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005727 -> tools/mkimage -n 'Simple Ramdisk Image' \
5728 > -A ppc -O linux -T ramdisk -C gzip \
5729 > -d /LinuxPPC/images/SIMPLE-ramdisk.image.gz examples/simple-initrd
5730 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
5731 Created: Wed Jan 12 14:01:50 2000
5732 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
5733 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553.25 kB = 0.54 MB
5734 Load Address: 0x00000000
5735 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005736
Guilherme Maciel Ferreiraa804b5c2013-12-01 12:43:11 -07005737The "dumpimage" is a tool to disassemble images built by mkimage. Its "-i"
5738option performs the converse operation of the mkimage's second form (the "-d"
5739option). Given an image built by mkimage, the dumpimage extracts a "data file"
5740from the image:
5741
5742 tools/dumpimage -i image -p position data_file
5743 -i ==> extract from the 'image' a specific 'data_file', \
5744 indexed by 'position'
5745
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005746
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005747Installing a Linux Image:
5748-------------------------
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005749
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005750To downloading a U-Boot image over the serial (console) interface,
5751you must convert the image to S-Record format:
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005752
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005753 objcopy -I binary -O srec examples/image examples/image.srec
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005754
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005755The 'objcopy' does not understand the information in the U-Boot
5756image header, so the resulting S-Record file will be relative to
5757address 0x00000000. To load it to a given address, you need to
5758specify the target address as 'offset' parameter with the 'loads'
5759command.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005760
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005761Example: install the image to address 0x40100000 (which on the
5762TQM8xxL is in the first Flash bank):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005763
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005764 => erase 40100000 401FFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005765
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005766 .......... done
5767 Erased 8 sectors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005768
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005769 => loads 40100000
5770 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
5771 ~>examples/image.srec
5772 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 ...
5773 ...
5774 15989 15990 15991 15992
5775 [file transfer complete]
5776 [connected]
5777 ## Start Addr = 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005778
5779
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005780You can check the success of the download using the 'iminfo' command;
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005781this includes a checksum verification so you can be sure no data
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005782corruption happened:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005783
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005784 => imi 40100000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005785
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005786 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
5787 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
5788 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5789 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
5790 Load Address: 00000000
5791 Entry Point: 0000000c
5792 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005793
5794
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005795Boot Linux:
5796-----------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005797
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005798The "bootm" command is used to boot an application that is stored in
5799memory (RAM or Flash). In case of a Linux kernel image, the contents
5800of the "bootargs" environment variable is passed to the kernel as
5801parameters. You can check and modify this variable using the
5802"printenv" and "setenv" commands:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005803
5804
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005805 => printenv bootargs
5806 bootargs=root=/dev/ram
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005807
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005808 => setenv bootargs root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005809
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005810 => printenv bootargs
5811 bootargs=root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005812
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005813 => bootm 40020000
5814 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40020000 ...
5815 Image Name: 2.2.13 for NFS on TQM850L
5816 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5817 Data Size: 381681 Bytes = 372 kB = 0 MB
5818 Load Address: 00000000
5819 Entry Point: 0000000c
5820 Verifying Checksum ... OK
5821 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
5822 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:35:17 MEST 2000
5823 Boot arguments: root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
5824 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
5825 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
5826 Memory: 15208k available (700k kernel code, 444k data, 32k init) [c0000000,c1000000]
5827 ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005828
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005829If you want to boot a Linux kernel with initial RAM disk, you pass
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005830the memory addresses of both the kernel and the initrd image (PPBCOOT
5831format!) to the "bootm" command:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005832
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005833 => imi 40100000 40200000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005834
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005835 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
5836 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
5837 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5838 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
5839 Load Address: 00000000
5840 Entry Point: 0000000c
5841 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005842
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005843 ## Checking Image at 40200000 ...
5844 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
5845 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
5846 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
5847 Load Address: 00000000
5848 Entry Point: 00000000
5849 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005850
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005851 => bootm 40100000 40200000
5852 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40100000 ...
5853 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
5854 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5855 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
5856 Load Address: 00000000
5857 Entry Point: 0000000c
5858 Verifying Checksum ... OK
5859 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
5860 ## Loading RAMDisk Image at 40200000 ...
5861 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
5862 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
5863 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
5864 Load Address: 00000000
5865 Entry Point: 00000000
5866 Verifying Checksum ... OK
5867 Loading Ramdisk ... OK
5868 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:32:08 MEST 2000
5869 Boot arguments: root=/dev/ram
5870 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
5871 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
5872 ...
5873 RAMDISK: Compressed image found at block 0
5874 VFS: Mounted root (ext2 filesystem).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005875
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005876 bash#
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005877
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05005878Boot Linux and pass a flat device tree:
5879-----------
5880
5881First, U-Boot must be compiled with the appropriate defines. See the section
5882titled "Linux Kernel Interface" above for a more in depth explanation. The
5883following is an example of how to start a kernel and pass an updated
5884flat device tree:
5885
5886=> print oftaddr
5887oftaddr=0x300000
5888=> print oft
5889oft=oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb
5890=> tftp $oftaddr $oft
5891Speed: 1000, full duplex
5892Using TSEC0 device
5893TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.101
5894Filename 'oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb'.
5895Load address: 0x300000
5896Loading: #
5897done
5898Bytes transferred = 4106 (100a hex)
5899=> tftp $loadaddr $bootfile
5900Speed: 1000, full duplex
5901Using TSEC0 device
5902TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.2
5903Filename 'uImage'.
5904Load address: 0x200000
5905Loading:############
5906done
5907Bytes transferred = 1029407 (fb51f hex)
5908=> print loadaddr
5909loadaddr=200000
5910=> print oftaddr
5911oftaddr=0x300000
5912=> bootm $loadaddr - $oftaddr
5913## Booting image at 00200000 ...
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01005914 Image Name: Linux-2.6.17-dirty
5915 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5916 Data Size: 1029343 Bytes = 1005.2 kB
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05005917 Load Address: 00000000
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01005918 Entry Point: 00000000
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05005919 Verifying Checksum ... OK
5920 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
5921Booting using flat device tree at 0x300000
5922Using MPC85xx ADS machine description
5923Memory CAM mapping: CAM0=256Mb, CAM1=256Mb, CAM2=0Mb residual: 0Mb
5924[snip]
5925
5926
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005927More About U-Boot Image Types:
5928------------------------------
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00005929
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005930U-Boot supports the following image types:
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00005931
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005932 "Standalone Programs" are directly runnable in the environment
5933 provided by U-Boot; it is expected that (if they behave
5934 well) you can continue to work in U-Boot after return from
5935 the Standalone Program.
5936 "OS Kernel Images" are usually images of some Embedded OS which
5937 will take over control completely. Usually these programs
5938 will install their own set of exception handlers, device
5939 drivers, set up the MMU, etc. - this means, that you cannot
5940 expect to re-enter U-Boot except by resetting the CPU.
5941 "RAMDisk Images" are more or less just data blocks, and their
5942 parameters (address, size) are passed to an OS kernel that is
5943 being started.
5944 "Multi-File Images" contain several images, typically an OS
5945 (Linux) kernel image and one or more data images like
5946 RAMDisks. This construct is useful for instance when you want
5947 to boot over the network using BOOTP etc., where the boot
5948 server provides just a single image file, but you want to get
5949 for instance an OS kernel and a RAMDisk image.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00005950
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005951 "Multi-File Images" start with a list of image sizes, each
5952 image size (in bytes) specified by an "uint32_t" in network
5953 byte order. This list is terminated by an "(uint32_t)0".
5954 Immediately after the terminating 0 follow the images, one by
5955 one, all aligned on "uint32_t" boundaries (size rounded up to
5956 a multiple of 4 bytes).
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00005957
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005958 "Firmware Images" are binary images containing firmware (like
5959 U-Boot or FPGA images) which usually will be programmed to
5960 flash memory.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00005961
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005962 "Script files" are command sequences that will be executed by
5963 U-Boot's command interpreter; this feature is especially
5964 useful when you configure U-Boot to use a real shell (hush)
5965 as command interpreter.
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00005966
Marek Vasut44f074c2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00005967Booting the Linux zImage:
5968-------------------------
5969
5970On some platforms, it's possible to boot Linux zImage. This is done
5971using the "bootz" command. The syntax of "bootz" command is the same
5972as the syntax of "bootm" command.
5973
Tom Rini8ac28562013-05-16 11:40:11 -04005974Note, defining the CONFIG_SUPPORT_RAW_INITRD allows user to supply
Marek Vasut017e1f32012-03-18 11:47:58 +00005975kernel with raw initrd images. The syntax is slightly different, the
5976address of the initrd must be augmented by it's size, in the following
5977format: "<initrd addres>:<initrd size>".
5978
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005979
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005980Standalone HOWTO:
5981=================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005982
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005983One of the features of U-Boot is that you can dynamically load and
5984run "standalone" applications, which can use some resources of
5985U-Boot like console I/O functions or interrupt services.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005986
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005987Two simple examples are included with the sources:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005988
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005989"Hello World" Demo:
5990-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005991
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005992'examples/hello_world.c' contains a small "Hello World" Demo
5993application; it is automatically compiled when you build U-Boot.
5994It's configured to run at address 0x00040004, so you can play with it
5995like that:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005996
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005997 => loads
5998 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
5999 ~>examples/hello_world.srec
6000 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
6001 [file transfer complete]
6002 [connected]
6003 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006004
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006005 => go 40004 Hello World! This is a test.
6006 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
6007 Hello World
6008 argc = 7
6009 argv[0] = "40004"
6010 argv[1] = "Hello"
6011 argv[2] = "World!"
6012 argv[3] = "This"
6013 argv[4] = "is"
6014 argv[5] = "a"
6015 argv[6] = "test."
6016 argv[7] = "<NULL>"
6017 Hit any key to exit ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006018
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006019 ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006020
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006021Another example, which demonstrates how to register a CPM interrupt
6022handler with the U-Boot code, can be found in 'examples/timer.c'.
6023Here, a CPM timer is set up to generate an interrupt every second.
6024The interrupt service routine is trivial, just printing a '.'
6025character, but this is just a demo program. The application can be
6026controlled by the following keys:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006027
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006028 ? - print current values og the CPM Timer registers
6029 b - enable interrupts and start timer
6030 e - stop timer and disable interrupts
6031 q - quit application
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006032
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006033 => loads
6034 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
6035 ~>examples/timer.srec
6036 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
6037 [file transfer complete]
6038 [connected]
6039 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006040
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006041 => go 40004
6042 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
6043 TIMERS=0xfff00980
6044 Using timer 1
6045 tgcr @ 0xfff00980, tmr @ 0xfff00990, trr @ 0xfff00994, tcr @ 0xfff00998, tcn @ 0xfff0099c, ter @ 0xfff009b0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006046
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006047Hit 'b':
6048 [q, b, e, ?] Set interval 1000000 us
6049 Enabling timer
6050Hit '?':
6051 [q, b, e, ?] ........
6052 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0xef6, ter=0x0
6053Hit '?':
6054 [q, b, e, ?] .
6055 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x2ad4, ter=0x0
6056Hit '?':
6057 [q, b, e, ?] .
6058 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x1efc, ter=0x0
6059Hit '?':
6060 [q, b, e, ?] .
6061 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x169d, ter=0x0
6062Hit 'e':
6063 [q, b, e, ?] ...Stopping timer
6064Hit 'q':
6065 [q, b, e, ?] ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006066
6067
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006068Minicom warning:
6069================
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00006070
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006071Over time, many people have reported problems when trying to use the
6072"minicom" terminal emulation program for serial download. I (wd)
6073consider minicom to be broken, and recommend not to use it. Under
6074Unix, I recommend to use C-Kermit for general purpose use (and
6075especially for kermit binary protocol download ("loadb" command), and
Karl O. Pince53515a2012-10-01 05:11:56 +00006076use "cu" for S-Record download ("loads" command). See
6077http://www.denx.de/wiki/view/DULG/SystemSetup#Section_4.3.
6078for help with kermit.
6079
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00006080
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006081Nevertheless, if you absolutely want to use it try adding this
6082configuration to your "File transfer protocols" section:
wdenk52f52c12003-06-19 23:04:19 +00006083
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006084 Name Program Name U/D FullScr IO-Red. Multi
6085 X kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -s Y U Y N N
6086 Y kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -r N D Y N N
wdenk52f52c12003-06-19 23:04:19 +00006087
6088
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006089NetBSD Notes:
6090=============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006091
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006092Starting at version 0.9.2, U-Boot supports NetBSD both as host
6093(build U-Boot) and target system (boots NetBSD/mpc8xx).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006094
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006095Building requires a cross environment; it is known to work on
6096NetBSD/i386 with the cross-powerpc-netbsd-1.3 package (you will also
6097need gmake since the Makefiles are not compatible with BSD make).
6098Note that the cross-powerpc package does not install include files;
6099attempting to build U-Boot will fail because <machine/ansi.h> is
6100missing. This file has to be installed and patched manually:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006101
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006102 # cd /usr/pkg/cross/powerpc-netbsd/include
6103 # mkdir powerpc
6104 # ln -s powerpc machine
6105 # cp /usr/src/sys/arch/powerpc/include/ansi.h powerpc/ansi.h
6106 # ${EDIT} powerpc/ansi.h ## must remove __va_list, _BSD_VA_LIST
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006107
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006108Native builds *don't* work due to incompatibilities between native
6109and U-Boot include files.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006110
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006111Booting assumes that (the first part of) the image booted is a
6112stage-2 loader which in turn loads and then invokes the kernel
6113proper. Loader sources will eventually appear in the NetBSD source
6114tree (probably in sys/arc/mpc8xx/stand/u-boot_stage2/); in the
wdenk2a8af182005-04-13 10:02:42 +00006115meantime, see ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/ppcboot_stage2.tar.gz
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006116
6117
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006118Implementation Internals:
6119=========================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006120
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006121The following is not intended to be a complete description of every
6122implementation detail. However, it should help to understand the
6123inner workings of U-Boot and make it easier to port it to custom
6124hardware.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006125
6126
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006127Initial Stack, Global Data:
6128---------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006129
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006130The implementation of U-Boot is complicated by the fact that U-Boot
6131starts running out of ROM (flash memory), usually without access to
6132system RAM (because the memory controller is not initialized yet).
6133This means that we don't have writable Data or BSS segments, and BSS
6134is not initialized as zero. To be able to get a C environment working
6135at all, we have to allocate at least a minimal stack. Implementation
6136options for this are defined and restricted by the CPU used: Some CPU
6137models provide on-chip memory (like the IMMR area on MPC8xx and
6138MPC826x processors), on others (parts of) the data cache can be
6139locked as (mis-) used as memory, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006140
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006141 Chris Hallinan posted a good summary of these issues to the
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01006142 U-Boot mailing list:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006143
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006144 Subject: RE: [U-Boot-Users] RE: More On Memory Bank x (nothingness)?
6145 From: "Chris Hallinan" <clh@net1plus.com>
6146 Date: Mon, 10 Feb 2003 16:43:46 -0500 (22:43 MET)
6147 ...
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006148
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006149 Correct me if I'm wrong, folks, but the way I understand it
6150 is this: Using DCACHE as initial RAM for Stack, etc, does not
6151 require any physical RAM backing up the cache. The cleverness
6152 is that the cache is being used as a temporary supply of
6153 necessary storage before the SDRAM controller is setup. It's
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02006154 beyond the scope of this list to explain the details, but you
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006155 can see how this works by studying the cache architecture and
6156 operation in the architecture and processor-specific manuals.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006157
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006158 OCM is On Chip Memory, which I believe the 405GP has 4K. It
6159 is another option for the system designer to use as an
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02006160 initial stack/RAM area prior to SDRAM being available. Either
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006161 option should work for you. Using CS 4 should be fine if your
6162 board designers haven't used it for something that would
6163 cause you grief during the initial boot! It is frequently not
6164 used.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006165
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02006166 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR should be somewhere that won't interfere
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006167 with your processor/board/system design. The default value
6168 you will find in any recent u-boot distribution in
Stefan Roese8a316c92005-08-01 16:49:12 +02006169 walnut.h should work for you. I'd set it to a value larger
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006170 than your SDRAM module. If you have a 64MB SDRAM module, set
6171 it above 400_0000. Just make sure your board has no resources
6172 that are supposed to respond to that address! That code in
6173 start.S has been around a while and should work as is when
6174 you get the config right.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006175
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006176 -Chris Hallinan
6177 DS4.COM, Inc.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006178
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006179It is essential to remember this, since it has some impact on the C
6180code for the initialization procedures:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006181
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006182* Initialized global data (data segment) is read-only. Do not attempt
6183 to write it.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006184
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02006185* Do not use any uninitialized global data (or implicitely initialized
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006186 as zero data - BSS segment) at all - this is undefined, initiali-
6187 zation is performed later (when relocating to RAM).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006188
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006189* Stack space is very limited. Avoid big data buffers or things like
6190 that.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006191
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006192Having only the stack as writable memory limits means we cannot use
6193normal global data to share information beween the code. But it
6194turned out that the implementation of U-Boot can be greatly
6195simplified by making a global data structure (gd_t) available to all
6196functions. We could pass a pointer to this data as argument to _all_
6197functions, but this would bloat the code. Instead we use a feature of
6198the GCC compiler (Global Register Variables) to share the data: we
6199place a pointer (gd) to the global data into a register which we
6200reserve for this purpose.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006201
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006202When choosing a register for such a purpose we are restricted by the
6203relevant (E)ABI specifications for the current architecture, and by
6204GCC's implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006205
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006206For PowerPC, the following registers have specific use:
6207 R1: stack pointer
Wolfgang Denke7670f62008-02-14 22:43:22 +01006208 R2: reserved for system use
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006209 R3-R4: parameter passing and return values
6210 R5-R10: parameter passing
6211 R13: small data area pointer
6212 R30: GOT pointer
6213 R31: frame pointer
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006214
Joakim Tjernlunde6bee802010-01-19 14:41:58 +01006215 (U-Boot also uses R12 as internal GOT pointer. r12
6216 is a volatile register so r12 needs to be reset when
6217 going back and forth between asm and C)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006218
Wolfgang Denke7670f62008-02-14 22:43:22 +01006219 ==> U-Boot will use R2 to hold a pointer to the global data
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006220
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006221 Note: on PPC, we could use a static initializer (since the
6222 address of the global data structure is known at compile time),
6223 but it turned out that reserving a register results in somewhat
6224 smaller code - although the code savings are not that big (on
6225 average for all boards 752 bytes for the whole U-Boot image,
6226 624 text + 127 data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006227
Robin Getzc4db3352009-08-17 15:23:02 +00006228On Blackfin, the normal C ABI (except for P3) is followed as documented here:
Mike Frysinger4c58eb52008-02-04 19:26:54 -05006229 http://docs.blackfin.uclinux.org/doku.php?id=application_binary_interface
6230
Robin Getzc4db3352009-08-17 15:23:02 +00006231 ==> U-Boot will use P3 to hold a pointer to the global data
Mike Frysinger4c58eb52008-02-04 19:26:54 -05006232
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006233On ARM, the following registers are used:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006234
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006235 R0: function argument word/integer result
6236 R1-R3: function argument word
Jeroen Hofstee12eba1b2013-09-21 14:04:42 +02006237 R9: platform specific
6238 R10: stack limit (used only if stack checking is enabled)
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006239 R11: argument (frame) pointer
6240 R12: temporary workspace
6241 R13: stack pointer
6242 R14: link register
6243 R15: program counter
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006244
Jeroen Hofstee12eba1b2013-09-21 14:04:42 +02006245 ==> U-Boot will use R9 to hold a pointer to the global data
6246
6247 Note: on ARM, only R_ARM_RELATIVE relocations are supported.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006248
Thomas Chou0df01fd2010-05-21 11:08:03 +08006249On Nios II, the ABI is documented here:
6250 http://www.altera.com/literature/hb/nios2/n2cpu_nii51016.pdf
6251
6252 ==> U-Boot will use gp to hold a pointer to the global data
6253
6254 Note: on Nios II, we give "-G0" option to gcc and don't use gp
6255 to access small data sections, so gp is free.
6256
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00006257On NDS32, the following registers are used:
6258
6259 R0-R1: argument/return
6260 R2-R5: argument
6261 R15: temporary register for assembler
6262 R16: trampoline register
6263 R28: frame pointer (FP)
6264 R29: global pointer (GP)
6265 R30: link register (LP)
6266 R31: stack pointer (SP)
6267 PC: program counter (PC)
6268
6269 ==> U-Boot will use R10 to hold a pointer to the global data
6270
Wolfgang Denkd87080b2006-03-31 18:32:53 +02006271NOTE: DECLARE_GLOBAL_DATA_PTR must be used with file-global scope,
6272or current versions of GCC may "optimize" the code too much.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006273
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006274Memory Management:
6275------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006276
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006277U-Boot runs in system state and uses physical addresses, i.e. the
6278MMU is not used either for address mapping nor for memory protection.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006279
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006280The available memory is mapped to fixed addresses using the memory
6281controller. In this process, a contiguous block is formed for each
6282memory type (Flash, SDRAM, SRAM), even when it consists of several
6283physical memory banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006284
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006285U-Boot is installed in the first 128 kB of the first Flash bank (on
6286TQM8xxL modules this is the range 0x40000000 ... 0x4001FFFF). After
6287booting and sizing and initializing DRAM, the code relocates itself
6288to the upper end of DRAM. Immediately below the U-Boot code some
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02006289memory is reserved for use by malloc() [see CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006290configuration setting]. Below that, a structure with global Board
6291Info data is placed, followed by the stack (growing downward).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006292
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006293Additionally, some exception handler code is copied to the low 8 kB
6294of DRAM (0x00000000 ... 0x00001FFF).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006295
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006296So a typical memory configuration with 16 MB of DRAM could look like
6297this:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006298
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006299 0x0000 0000 Exception Vector code
6300 :
6301 0x0000 1FFF
6302 0x0000 2000 Free for Application Use
6303 :
6304 :
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006305
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006306 :
6307 :
6308 0x00FB FF20 Monitor Stack (Growing downward)
6309 0x00FB FFAC Board Info Data and permanent copy of global data
6310 0x00FC 0000 Malloc Arena
6311 :
6312 0x00FD FFFF
6313 0x00FE 0000 RAM Copy of Monitor Code
6314 ... eventually: LCD or video framebuffer
6315 ... eventually: pRAM (Protected RAM - unchanged by reset)
6316 0x00FF FFFF [End of RAM]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006317
6318
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006319System Initialization:
6320----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006321
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006322In the reset configuration, U-Boot starts at the reset entry point
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02006323(on most PowerPC systems at address 0x00000100). Because of the reset
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006324configuration for CS0# this is a mirror of the onboard Flash memory.
6325To be able to re-map memory U-Boot then jumps to its link address.
6326To be able to implement the initialization code in C, a (small!)
6327initial stack is set up in the internal Dual Ported RAM (in case CPUs
6328which provide such a feature like MPC8xx or MPC8260), or in a locked
6329part of the data cache. After that, U-Boot initializes the CPU core,
6330the caches and the SIU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006331
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006332Next, all (potentially) available memory banks are mapped using a
6333preliminary mapping. For example, we put them on 512 MB boundaries
6334(multiples of 0x20000000: SDRAM on 0x00000000 and 0x20000000, Flash
6335on 0x40000000 and 0x60000000, SRAM on 0x80000000). Then UPM A is
6336programmed for SDRAM access. Using the temporary configuration, a
6337simple memory test is run that determines the size of the SDRAM
6338banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006339
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006340When there is more than one SDRAM bank, and the banks are of
6341different size, the largest is mapped first. For equal size, the first
6342bank (CS2#) is mapped first. The first mapping is always for address
63430x00000000, with any additional banks following immediately to create
6344contiguous memory starting from 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006345
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006346Then, the monitor installs itself at the upper end of the SDRAM area
6347and allocates memory for use by malloc() and for the global Board
6348Info data; also, the exception vector code is copied to the low RAM
6349pages, and the final stack is set up.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006350
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006351Only after this relocation will you have a "normal" C environment;
6352until that you are restricted in several ways, mostly because you are
6353running from ROM, and because the code will have to be relocated to a
6354new address in RAM.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006355
6356
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006357U-Boot Porting Guide:
6358----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006359
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006360[Based on messages by Jerry Van Baren in the U-Boot-Users mailing
6361list, October 2002]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006362
6363
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006364int main(int argc, char *argv[])
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006365{
6366 sighandler_t no_more_time;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006367
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006368 signal(SIGALRM, no_more_time);
6369 alarm(PROJECT_DEADLINE - toSec (3 * WEEK));
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006370
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006371 if (available_money > available_manpower) {
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006372 Pay consultant to port U-Boot;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006373 return 0;
6374 }
6375
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006376 Download latest U-Boot source;
6377
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01006378 Subscribe to u-boot mailing list;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006379
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006380 if (clueless)
6381 email("Hi, I am new to U-Boot, how do I get started?");
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006382
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006383 while (learning) {
6384 Read the README file in the top level directory;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006385 Read http://www.denx.de/twiki/bin/view/DULG/Manual;
6386 Read applicable doc/*.README;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006387 Read the source, Luke;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006388 /* find . -name "*.[chS]" | xargs grep -i <keyword> */
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006389 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006390
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006391 if (available_money > toLocalCurrency ($2500))
6392 Buy a BDI3000;
6393 else
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006394 Add a lot of aggravation and time;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006395
6396 if (a similar board exists) { /* hopefully... */
6397 cp -a board/<similar> board/<myboard>
6398 cp include/configs/<similar>.h include/configs/<myboard>.h
6399 } else {
6400 Create your own board support subdirectory;
6401 Create your own board include/configs/<myboard>.h file;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006402 }
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006403 Edit new board/<myboard> files
6404 Edit new include/configs/<myboard>.h
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006405
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006406 while (!accepted) {
6407 while (!running) {
6408 do {
6409 Add / modify source code;
6410 } until (compiles);
6411 Debug;
6412 if (clueless)
6413 email("Hi, I am having problems...");
6414 }
6415 Send patch file to the U-Boot email list;
6416 if (reasonable critiques)
6417 Incorporate improvements from email list code review;
6418 else
6419 Defend code as written;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006420 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006421
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006422 return 0;
6423}
6424
6425void no_more_time (int sig)
6426{
6427 hire_a_guru();
6428}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006429
6430
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006431Coding Standards:
6432-----------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006433
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006434All contributions to U-Boot should conform to the Linux kernel
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02006435coding style; see the file "Documentation/CodingStyle" and the script
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00006436"scripts/Lindent" in your Linux kernel source directory.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006437
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02006438Source files originating from a different project (for example the
6439MTD subsystem) are generally exempt from these guidelines and are not
6440reformated to ease subsequent migration to newer versions of those
6441sources.
6442
6443Please note that U-Boot is implemented in C (and to some small parts in
6444Assembler); no C++ is used, so please do not use C++ style comments (//)
6445in your code.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006446
6447Please also stick to the following formatting rules:
6448- remove any trailing white space
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00006449- use TAB characters for indentation and vertical alignment, not spaces
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006450- make sure NOT to use DOS '\r\n' line feeds
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00006451- do not add more than 2 consecutive empty lines to source files
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006452- do not add trailing empty lines to source files
6453
6454Submissions which do not conform to the standards may be returned
6455with a request to reformat the changes.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006456
6457
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006458Submitting Patches:
6459-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006460
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006461Since the number of patches for U-Boot is growing, we need to
6462establish some rules. Submissions which do not conform to these rules
6463may be rejected, even when they contain important and valuable stuff.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006464
Magnus Lilja0d28f342008-08-06 19:32:33 +02006465Please see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/Patches for details.
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006466
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01006467Patches shall be sent to the u-boot mailing list <u-boot@lists.denx.de>;
6468see http://lists.denx.de/mailman/listinfo/u-boot
6469
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006470When you send a patch, please include the following information with
6471it:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006472
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006473* For bug fixes: a description of the bug and how your patch fixes
6474 this bug. Please try to include a way of demonstrating that the
6475 patch actually fixes something.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006476
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006477* For new features: a description of the feature and your
6478 implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006479
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006480* A CHANGELOG entry as plaintext (separate from the patch)
6481
6482* For major contributions, your entry to the CREDITS file
6483
Albert ARIBAUD27af9302013-09-11 15:52:51 +02006484* When you add support for a new board, don't forget to add a
6485 maintainer e-mail address to the boards.cfg file, too.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006486
6487* If your patch adds new configuration options, don't forget to
6488 document these in the README file.
6489
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006490* The patch itself. If you are using git (which is *strongly*
6491 recommended) you can easily generate the patch using the
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00006492 "git format-patch". If you then use "git send-email" to send it to
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006493 the U-Boot mailing list, you will avoid most of the common problems
6494 with some other mail clients.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006495
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006496 If you cannot use git, use "diff -purN OLD NEW". If your version of
6497 diff does not support these options, then get the latest version of
6498 GNU diff.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006499
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006500 The current directory when running this command shall be the parent
6501 directory of the U-Boot source tree (i. e. please make sure that
6502 your patch includes sufficient directory information for the
6503 affected files).
6504
6505 We prefer patches as plain text. MIME attachments are discouraged,
6506 and compressed attachments must not be used.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006507
6508* If one logical set of modifications affects or creates several
6509 files, all these changes shall be submitted in a SINGLE patch file.
6510
6511* Changesets that contain different, unrelated modifications shall be
6512 submitted as SEPARATE patches, one patch per changeset.
6513
6514
6515Notes:
6516
6517* Before sending the patch, run the MAKEALL script on your patched
6518 source tree and make sure that no errors or warnings are reported
6519 for any of the boards.
6520
6521* Keep your modifications to the necessary minimum: A patch
6522 containing several unrelated changes or arbitrary reformats will be
6523 returned with a request to re-formatting / split it.
6524
6525* If you modify existing code, make sure that your new code does not
6526 add to the memory footprint of the code ;-) Small is beautiful!
6527 When adding new features, these should compile conditionally only
6528 (using #ifdef), and the resulting code with the new feature
6529 disabled must not need more memory than the old code without your
6530 modification.
wdenk90dc6702005-05-03 14:12:25 +00006531
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01006532* Remember that there is a size limit of 100 kB per message on the
6533 u-boot mailing list. Bigger patches will be moderated. If they are
6534 reasonable and not too big, they will be acknowledged. But patches
6535 bigger than the size limit should be avoided.